Always pass signals to the right thread
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include <string.h>
40 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
41 #include "filenames.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "valprint.h"
61 #include "jit.h"
62 #include "xml-syscall.h"
63 #include "parser-defs.h"
64 #include "gdb_regex.h"
65 #include "probe.h"
66 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
67 #include "continuations.h"
68 #include "stack.h"
69 #include "skip.h"
70 #include "ax-gdb.h"
71 #include "dummy-frame.h"
72
73 #include "format.h"
74
75 /* readline include files */
76 #include "readline/readline.h"
77 #include "readline/history.h"
78
79 /* readline defines this. */
80 #undef savestring
81
82 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
83 #include "extension.h"
84
85 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
86 enum exception_event_kind
87 {
88 EX_EVENT_THROW,
89 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
90 EX_EVENT_CATCH
91 };
92
93 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
94
95 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
96
97 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
98
99 static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
100
101 static void disable_command (char *, int);
102
103 static void enable_command (char *, int);
104
105 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
106 void *),
107 void *);
108
109 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
110
111 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
112
113 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
114
115 static void create_sals_from_address_default (char **,
116 struct linespec_result *,
117 enum bptype, char *,
118 char **);
119
120 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
121 struct linespec_result *,
122 char *, char *, enum bptype,
123 enum bpdisp, int, int,
124 int,
125 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
126 int, int, int, unsigned);
127
128 static void decode_linespec_default (struct breakpoint *, char **,
129 struct symtabs_and_lines *);
130
131 static void clear_command (char *, int);
132
133 static void catch_command (char *, int);
134
135 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
136
137 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
138
139 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
140
141 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
142 enum bptype,
143 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
144 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
145 const struct symtab_and_line *);
146
147 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
148 static. */
149 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
150 struct symtab_and_line,
151 enum bptype,
152 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
153
154 static struct breakpoint *
155 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
156 enum bptype type,
157 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
158 int loc_enabled);
159
160 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
161
162 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
163 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
164 enum bptype bptype);
165
166 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
167 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
168 struct obj_section *, int);
169
170 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
171 struct bp_location *loc2);
172
173 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
174 struct address_space *aspace,
175 CORE_ADDR addr);
176
177 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
178
179 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
180
181 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
182 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
183
184 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
185
186 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
187
188 static void commands_command (char *, int);
189
190 static void condition_command (char *, int);
191
192 typedef enum
193 {
194 mark_inserted,
195 mark_uninserted
196 }
197 insertion_state_t;
198
199 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
200 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
201
202 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
203
204 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
205
206 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
207
208 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
209
210 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
211
212 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
213 enum bptype type,
214 int *other_type_used);
215
216 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
217
218 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
219
220 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
221 int count);
222
223 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
224
225 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
226
227 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
228
229 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
230
231 static void detach_single_step_breakpoints (void);
232
233 static int find_single_step_breakpoint (struct address_space *aspace,
234 CORE_ADDR pc);
235
236 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
237 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
238 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
239
240 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
241
242 static void update_global_location_list (int);
243
244 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
245
246 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
247
248 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
249
250 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
251
252 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
253
254 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
255
256 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
257
258 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
259
260 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
261
262 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
263
264 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
265
266 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
267
268 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
269 otherwise. */
270
271 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
272
273 /* The abstract base class all breakpoint_ops structures inherit
274 from. */
275 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops;
276
277 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
278 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
279 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
280 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
281
282 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
283 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
284
285 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
286 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
287
288 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
289 static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
290
291 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
292 breakpoints. */
293 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
294
295 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
296 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
297
298 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
299 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
300
301 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single
302 stepping. */
303
304 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
305 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
306
307 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
308 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
309 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
310 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
311 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
312 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
313
314 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
315 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
316 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
317 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
318 dprintf_style_gdb,
319 dprintf_style_call,
320 dprintf_style_agent,
321 NULL
322 };
323 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
324
325 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
326 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
327 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
328 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
329
330 static char *dprintf_function = "";
331
332 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
333 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
334 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
335 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
336 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
337 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
338 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
339
340 static char *dprintf_channel = "";
341
342 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
343 has disconnected. */
344 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
345
346 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
347 breakpoints share a single command list. */
348 struct counted_command_line
349 {
350 /* The reference count. */
351 int refc;
352
353 /* The command list. */
354 struct command_line *commands;
355 };
356
357 struct command_line *
358 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
359 {
360 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
361 }
362
363 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
364 current breakpoint. */
365
366 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
367
368 const char *
369 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
370 {
371 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
372 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
373 a breakpoint. */
374 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
375
376 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
377 }
378
379 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
380 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
381 if such is available. */
382 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
383
384 static void
385 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
386 struct cmd_list_element *c,
387 const char *value)
388 {
389 fprintf_filtered (file,
390 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
391 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
392 value);
393 }
394
395 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
396 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
397 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
398 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
399 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
400 static void
401 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
402 struct cmd_list_element *c,
403 const char *value)
404 {
405 fprintf_filtered (file,
406 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
407 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
408 value);
409 }
410
411 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
412 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
413 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
414 use hardware breakpoints. */
415 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
416 static void
417 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
418 struct cmd_list_element *c,
419 const char *value)
420 {
421 fprintf_filtered (file,
422 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
423 value);
424 }
425
426 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
427 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
428 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
429 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
430 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
431
432 static enum auto_boolean always_inserted_mode = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
433
434 static void
435 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
436 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
437 {
438 if (always_inserted_mode == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO)
439 fprintf_filtered (file,
440 _("Always inserted breakpoint "
441 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
442 value,
443 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
444 else
445 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
446 value);
447 }
448
449 int
450 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
451 {
452 return (always_inserted_mode == AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE
453 || (always_inserted_mode == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO && non_stop));
454 }
455
456 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
457
458 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
459 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
460 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
461 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
462 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
463 condition_evaluation_auto,
464 condition_evaluation_host,
465 condition_evaluation_target,
466 NULL
467 };
468
469 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
470 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
471
472 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
473 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
474 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
475
476 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
477 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
478 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
479 evaluation mode. */
480
481 static const char *
482 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
483 {
484 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
485 {
486 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
487 return condition_evaluation_target;
488 else
489 return condition_evaluation_host;
490 }
491 else
492 return mode;
493 }
494
495 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
496
497 static const char *
498 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
499 {
500 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
501 }
502
503 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
504 otherwise. */
505
506 static int
507 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
508 {
509 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
510
511 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
512 }
513
514 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
515
516 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
517 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
518
519 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
520 static int overlay_events_enabled;
521
522 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
523 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
524
525 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
526 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
527 current breakpoint. */
528
529 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
530
531 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
532 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
533 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
534 B = TMP)
535
536 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
537 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
538 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
539
540 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
541 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
542 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
543 BP_TMP++)
544
545 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
546 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
547 to where the loop should start from.
548 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
549 appropriate location to start with. */
550
551 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
552 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
553 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
554 BP_LOCP_START \
555 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
556 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
557 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
558
559 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
560
561 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
562 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
563 if (is_tracepoint (B))
564
565 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
566
567 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
568
569 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
570
571 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
572
573 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
574
575 static unsigned bp_location_count;
576
577 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
578 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
579 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
580 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
581 an address you need to read. */
582
583 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
584
585 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
586 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
587 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
588 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
589 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
590
591 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
592
593 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
594 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
595 by a target. */
596 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
597
598 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
599
600 static int breakpoint_count;
601
602 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
603 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
604 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
605 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
606 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
607
608 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
609
610 static int tracepoint_count;
611
612 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
613 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
614 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
615
616 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
617 static int
618 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
619 {
620 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
621 }
622
623 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
624
625 static void
626 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
627 {
628 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
629 breakpoint_count = num;
630 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
631 }
632
633 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
634 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
635 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
636
637 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
638 breakpoint made. */
639
640 void
641 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
642 {
643 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
644 }
645
646 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
647 breakpoint made. */
648
649 void
650 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
651 {
652 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
653 }
654
655 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
656
657 void
658 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
659 {
660 struct breakpoint *b;
661
662 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
663 b->hit_count = 0;
664 }
665
666 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
667 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
668
669 static struct counted_command_line *
670 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
671 {
672 struct counted_command_line *result
673 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct counted_command_line));
674
675 result->refc = 1;
676 result->commands = commands;
677 return result;
678 }
679
680 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
681
682 static void
683 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
684 {
685 if (cmd)
686 ++cmd->refc;
687 }
688
689 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
690 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
691 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
692
693 static void
694 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
695 {
696 if (*cmdp)
697 {
698 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
699 {
700 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
701 xfree (*cmdp);
702 }
703 *cmdp = NULL;
704 }
705 }
706
707 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
708
709 static void
710 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
711 {
712 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
713 }
714
715 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
716 argument. */
717
718 static struct cleanup *
719 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
720 {
721 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
722 }
723
724 \f
725 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
726 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
727
728 struct breakpoint *
729 get_breakpoint (int num)
730 {
731 struct breakpoint *b;
732
733 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
734 if (b->number == num)
735 return b;
736
737 return NULL;
738 }
739
740 \f
741
742 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
743 evaluating conditions on its side. */
744
745 static void
746 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
747 {
748 struct bp_location *loc;
749
750 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
751 evaluating conditions and if the user has
752 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
753 side. */
754 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
755 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
756 return;
757
758 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
759 return;
760
761 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
762 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
763 }
764
765 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
766 evaluating conditions on its side. */
767
768 static void
769 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
770 {
771 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
772 evaluating conditions and if the user has
773 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
774 side. */
775 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
776 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
777
778 return;
779
780 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
781 return;
782
783 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
784 }
785
786 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
787 condition_evaluation_mode. */
788
789 static void
790 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
791 struct cmd_list_element *c)
792 {
793 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
794
795 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
796 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
797 {
798 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
799 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
800 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
801 return;
802 }
803
804 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
805 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
806
807 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
808 settings was "auto". */
809 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
810
811 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
812 if (new_mode != old_mode)
813 {
814 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
815 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
816 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
817
818 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
819 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
820 */
821
822 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
823 {
824 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
825 target. */
826 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
827 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
828 }
829 else
830 {
831 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
832 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
833 target knows about. */
834 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
835 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
836 loc->needs_update = 1;
837 }
838
839 /* Do the update. */
840 update_global_location_list (1);
841 }
842
843 return;
844 }
845
846 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
847 what "auto" is translating to. */
848
849 static void
850 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
851 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
852 {
853 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
854 fprintf_filtered (file,
855 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
856 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
857 value,
858 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
859 else
860 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
861 value);
862 }
863
864 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
865 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
866 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
867
868 static int
869 bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
870 {
871 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
872 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
873
874 if (a->address == b->address)
875 return 0;
876 else
877 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
878 }
879
880 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
881 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
882 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
883 return NULL. */
884
885 static struct bp_location **
886 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
887 {
888 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
889 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
890 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
891
892 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
893 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
894 dummy_loc.address = address;
895
896 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
897 locp_found = bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
898 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
899 bp_location_compare_addrs);
900
901 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
902 if (locp_found == NULL)
903 return NULL;
904
905 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
906 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
907 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
908 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
909 locp_found--;
910
911 return locp_found;
912 }
913
914 void
915 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, char *exp,
916 int from_tty)
917 {
918 xfree (b->cond_string);
919 b->cond_string = NULL;
920
921 if (is_watchpoint (b))
922 {
923 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
924
925 xfree (w->cond_exp);
926 w->cond_exp = NULL;
927 }
928 else
929 {
930 struct bp_location *loc;
931
932 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
933 {
934 xfree (loc->cond);
935 loc->cond = NULL;
936
937 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
938 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
939 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
940 }
941 }
942
943 if (*exp == 0)
944 {
945 if (from_tty)
946 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
947 }
948 else
949 {
950 const char *arg = exp;
951
952 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
953 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
954 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
955 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
956
957 if (is_watchpoint (b))
958 {
959 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
960
961 innermost_block = NULL;
962 arg = exp;
963 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
964 if (*arg)
965 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
966 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
967 }
968 else
969 {
970 struct bp_location *loc;
971
972 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
973 {
974 arg = exp;
975 loc->cond =
976 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
977 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
978 if (*arg)
979 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
980 }
981 }
982 }
983 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
984
985 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
986 }
987
988 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
989
990 static VEC (char_ptr) *
991 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
992 const char *text, const char *word)
993 {
994 const char *space;
995
996 text = skip_spaces_const (text);
997 space = skip_to_space_const (text);
998 if (*space == '\0')
999 {
1000 int len;
1001 struct breakpoint *b;
1002 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
1003
1004 if (text[0] == '$')
1005 {
1006 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1007 if (isdigit (text[1]))
1008 return NULL;
1009 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
1010 }
1011
1012 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1013 len = strlen (text);
1014
1015 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1016 {
1017 char number[50];
1018
1019 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1020
1021 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1022 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number));
1023 }
1024
1025 return result;
1026 }
1027
1028 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1029 text = skip_spaces_const (space);
1030 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1031 }
1032
1033 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1034
1035 static void
1036 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1037 {
1038 struct breakpoint *b;
1039 char *p;
1040 int bnum;
1041
1042 if (arg == 0)
1043 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1044
1045 p = arg;
1046 bnum = get_number (&p);
1047 if (bnum == 0)
1048 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1049
1050 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1051 if (b->number == bnum)
1052 {
1053 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1054 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1055 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1056 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1057 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1058
1059 if (extlang != NULL)
1060 {
1061 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1062 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1063 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1064 }
1065 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1066
1067 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1068 update_global_location_list (1);
1069
1070 return;
1071 }
1072
1073 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1074 }
1075
1076 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1077 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1078 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1079
1080 static void
1081 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1082 {
1083 struct command_line *c;
1084
1085 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1086 {
1087 int i;
1088
1089 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1090 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1091 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1092
1093 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1094 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1095
1096 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1097 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1098 command directly. */
1099 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1100 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1101
1102 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1103 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1104 }
1105 }
1106
1107 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1108
1109 static int
1110 is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1111 {
1112 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1113 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1114 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1115 }
1116
1117 int
1118 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1119 {
1120 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1121 }
1122
1123 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1124 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1125 found. */
1126
1127 static void
1128 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1129 struct command_line *commands)
1130 {
1131 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1132 {
1133 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1134 struct command_line *c;
1135 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1136
1137 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1138 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1139 ones might not. */
1140 t->step_count = 0;
1141
1142 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1143 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1144 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1145 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1146 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1147 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1148 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1149 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1150 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1151 tracepoint's context. */
1152 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1153 {
1154 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1155 {
1156 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1157 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1158 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1159 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1160 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1161 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1162
1163 if (while_stepping)
1164 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1165 "can be used only once"));
1166 else
1167 while_stepping = c;
1168 }
1169
1170 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1171 }
1172 if (while_stepping)
1173 {
1174 struct command_line *c2;
1175
1176 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1177 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1178 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1179 {
1180 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1181 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1182 }
1183 }
1184 }
1185 else
1186 {
1187 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1188 }
1189 }
1190
1191 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1192 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1193
1194 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1195 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1196 {
1197 struct breakpoint *b;
1198 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1199 struct bp_location *loc;
1200
1201 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1202 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1203 {
1204 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1205 if (loc->address == addr)
1206 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1207 }
1208
1209 return found;
1210 }
1211
1212 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1213 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1214
1215 void
1216 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1217 struct command_line *commands)
1218 {
1219 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1220
1221 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1222 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1223 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1224 }
1225
1226 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1227 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1228 commands. */
1229
1230 void
1231 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1232 {
1233 int old_silent = b->silent;
1234
1235 b->silent = silent;
1236 if (old_silent != silent)
1237 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1238 }
1239
1240 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1241 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1242
1243 void
1244 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1245 {
1246 int old_thread = b->thread;
1247
1248 b->thread = thread;
1249 if (old_thread != thread)
1250 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1251 }
1252
1253 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1254 breakpoint work for any task. */
1255
1256 void
1257 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1258 {
1259 int old_task = b->task;
1260
1261 b->task = task;
1262 if (old_task != task)
1263 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1264 }
1265
1266 void
1267 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1268 {
1269 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
1270
1271 validate_actionline (line, b);
1272 }
1273
1274 /* A structure used to pass information through
1275 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1276
1277 struct commands_info
1278 {
1279 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1280 int from_tty;
1281
1282 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1283 char *arg;
1284
1285 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1286 already-parsed command. */
1287 struct command_line *control;
1288
1289 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1290 yet been read. */
1291 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1292 };
1293
1294 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1295 commands_command. */
1296
1297 static void
1298 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1299 {
1300 struct commands_info *info = data;
1301
1302 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1303 {
1304 struct command_line *l;
1305
1306 if (info->control != NULL)
1307 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1308 else
1309 {
1310 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1311 char *str;
1312
1313 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1314 "%s, one per line."),
1315 info->arg);
1316
1317 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1318
1319 l = read_command_lines (str,
1320 info->from_tty, 1,
1321 (is_tracepoint (b)
1322 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1323 b);
1324
1325 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1326 }
1327
1328 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1329 }
1330
1331 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1332 do anything. */
1333 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1334 {
1335 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1336 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1337 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1338 b->commands = info->cmd;
1339 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1340 }
1341 }
1342
1343 static void
1344 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1345 struct command_line *control)
1346 {
1347 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1348 struct commands_info info;
1349
1350 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1351 info.control = control;
1352 info.cmd = NULL;
1353 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1354 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1355 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1356
1357 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1358 {
1359 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1360 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1361 breakpoint_count);
1362 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1363 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1364 else
1365 {
1366 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1367 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1368 numbers will fail in this case. */
1369 arg = NULL;
1370 }
1371 }
1372 else
1373 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1374 our argument. */
1375 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1376
1377 if (arg != NULL)
1378 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1379
1380 info.arg = arg;
1381
1382 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1383
1384 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1385 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1386
1387 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1388 }
1389
1390 static void
1391 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1392 {
1393 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1394 }
1395
1396 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1397 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1398
1399 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1400 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1401 enum command_control_type
1402 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1403 {
1404 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1405 return simple_control;
1406 }
1407
1408 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1409
1410 static int
1411 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1412 {
1413 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1414 return 0;
1415 if (!bl->inserted)
1416 return 0;
1417 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1418 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1419 return 0;
1420 return 1;
1421 }
1422
1423 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1424 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1425 contents.
1426
1427 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1428 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1429 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1430
1431 static void
1432 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1433 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1434 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1435 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1436 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1437 {
1438 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1439 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1440 int bp_size = 0;
1441 int bptoffset = 0;
1442
1443 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1444 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1445 {
1446 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1447 return;
1448 }
1449
1450 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1451 we need to copy. */
1452 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1453 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1454
1455 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1456 {
1457 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1458 reading. */
1459 return;
1460 }
1461
1462 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1463 {
1464 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1465 reading. */
1466 return;
1467 }
1468
1469 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1470 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1471 {
1472 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1473 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1474 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1475 bp_addr = memaddr;
1476 }
1477
1478 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1479 {
1480 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1481 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1482 }
1483
1484 if (readbuf != NULL)
1485 {
1486 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1487 shadow_contents buffer. */
1488 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1489 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1490 + target_info->shadow_len));
1491
1492 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1493 shadow. */
1494 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1495 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1496 }
1497 else
1498 {
1499 const unsigned char *bp;
1500 CORE_ADDR placed_address = target_info->placed_address;
1501 int placed_size = target_info->placed_size;
1502
1503 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1504 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1505 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1506
1507 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1508 address. */
1509 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &placed_address, &placed_size);
1510
1511 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1512 breakpoint's INSN. */
1513 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1514 }
1515 }
1516
1517 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1518 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1519
1520 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1521 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1522 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1523
1524 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1525 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1526 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1527 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1528 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1529 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1530 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1531 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1532 and:
1533 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1534
1535 void
1536 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1537 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1538 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1539 {
1540 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1541 search. */
1542 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1543 size_t i;
1544
1545 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1546 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1547 report higher one. */
1548
1549 bc_l = 0;
1550 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1551 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1552 {
1553 struct bp_location *bl;
1554
1555 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1556 bl = bp_location[bc];
1557
1558 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1559 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1560 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1561 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1562
1563 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1564 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1565 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1566
1567 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1568 >= bl->address)
1569 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1570 <= memaddr))
1571 bc_l = bc;
1572 else
1573 bc_r = bc;
1574 }
1575
1576 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1577 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1578 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1579 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1580 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1581 B:
1582
1583 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1584
1585 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1586 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1587 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1588 and L2. */
1589 while (bc_l > 0
1590 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1591 bc_l--;
1592
1593 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1594
1595 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1596 {
1597 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1598 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1599 int bp_size = 0;
1600 int bptoffset = 0;
1601
1602 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1603 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1604 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1605 bl->owner->number);
1606
1607 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1608 content. */
1609
1610 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1611 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1612 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1613 break;
1614
1615 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1616 continue;
1617
1618 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1619 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1620 }
1621
1622 /* Now process single-step breakpoints. These are not found in the
1623 bp_location array. */
1624 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
1625 {
1626 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
1627
1628 if (bp_tgt != NULL)
1629 {
1630 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = single_step_gdbarch[i];
1631
1632 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1633 memaddr, len, bp_tgt, gdbarch);
1634 }
1635 }
1636 }
1637
1638 \f
1639
1640 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1641 breakpoint. */
1642
1643 int
1644 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1645 {
1646 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1647 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1648 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1649 }
1650
1651 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1652
1653 static int
1654 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1655 {
1656 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1657 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1658 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1659 }
1660
1661 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1662 software. */
1663
1664 int
1665 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1666 {
1667 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1668 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1669 }
1670
1671 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1672 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1673 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1674 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1675 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1676 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1677 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1678 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1679
1680 static int
1681 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1682 {
1683 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1684 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1685 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1686 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1687 }
1688
1689 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1690 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1691
1692 static void
1693 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1694 {
1695 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1696
1697 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1698 {
1699 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1700 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1701 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1702 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1703 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1704 }
1705 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1706 }
1707
1708 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1709 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1710 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1711 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1712 in b->loc->cond.
1713 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1714
1715 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1716 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1717 it.
1718
1719 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1720 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1721 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1722 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1723 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1724 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1725 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1726 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1727
1728 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1729 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1730 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1731 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1732 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1733 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1734 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1735 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1736 not changed.
1737
1738 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1739 hardware watchpoints:
1740
1741 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1742 called several times when GDB stops.
1743
1744 [linux]
1745 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1746 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1747 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1748 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1749 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1750 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1751 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1752 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1753 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1754 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1755 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1756
1757 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1758 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1759
1760 static void
1761 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1762 {
1763 int within_current_scope;
1764 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1765 int frame_saved;
1766
1767 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1768 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1769 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1770 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1771 return;
1772
1773 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1774 return;
1775
1776 frame_saved = 0;
1777
1778 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1779 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1780 within_current_scope = 1;
1781 else
1782 {
1783 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1784 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1785 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1786
1787 /* If we're in a function epilogue, unwinding may not work
1788 properly, so do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1789 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1790 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1791 return;
1792
1793 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1794 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1795 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1796 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1797 selected frame. */
1798 frame_saved = 1;
1799 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1800
1801 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1802 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1803 if (within_current_scope)
1804 select_frame (fi);
1805 }
1806
1807 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1808 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1809 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1810 b->base.loc = NULL;
1811
1812 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1813 {
1814 const char *s;
1815
1816 if (b->exp)
1817 {
1818 xfree (b->exp);
1819 b->exp = NULL;
1820 }
1821 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1822 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1823 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1824 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1825 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1826 be completely different objects. */
1827 value_free (b->val);
1828 b->val = NULL;
1829 b->val_valid = 0;
1830
1831 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1832 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1833 locations (re)created below. */
1834 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1835 {
1836 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1837 {
1838 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1839 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1840 }
1841
1842 s = b->base.cond_string;
1843 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1844 }
1845 }
1846
1847 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1848 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1849 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1850 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1851 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1852 if (!target_has_execution)
1853 {
1854 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1855 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1856 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1857 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1858 {
1859 if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1860 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1861 else
1862 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1863 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1864 }
1865 }
1866 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1867 {
1868 int pc = 0;
1869 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1870 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1871
1872 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1873
1874 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1875 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1876 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1877 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1878 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1879 watchpoints. */
1880 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1881 {
1882 b->val = v;
1883 b->val_valid = 1;
1884 }
1885
1886 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1887
1888 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1889 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1890 {
1891 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1892 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1893 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1894 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1895 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1896 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1897 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1898 {
1899 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1900
1901 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1902 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1903 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1904 if (v == result
1905 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1906 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1907 {
1908 CORE_ADDR addr;
1909 int type;
1910 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1911
1912 addr = value_address (v);
1913 type = hw_write;
1914 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1915 type = hw_read;
1916 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1917 type = hw_access;
1918
1919 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
1920 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1921 ;
1922 *tmp = loc;
1923 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1924
1925 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1926 loc->address = addr;
1927 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1928 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1929 }
1930 }
1931 }
1932
1933 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1934 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1935 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1936 is started. */
1937 if (reparse)
1938 {
1939 int reg_cnt;
1940 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1941 struct bp_location *bl;
1942
1943 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1944
1945 if (reg_cnt)
1946 {
1947 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1948 enum bptype type;
1949
1950 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1951 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1952 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1953
1954 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1955 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1956 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1957 this watchpoint in as well. */
1958
1959 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1960 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1961 hardware watchpoint type. */
1962 type = b->base.type;
1963 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1964 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1965
1966 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1967 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1968 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1969 through watch_command), so always account for it
1970 manually. */
1971
1972 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1973 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
1974
1975 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1976 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
1977
1978 target_resources_ok
1979 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1980 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1981 {
1982 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
1983
1984 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1985 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1986 "hardware watchpoint."));
1987 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1988 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1989 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1990
1991 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1992 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1993 }
1994 else
1995 {
1996 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1997 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1998 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1999 nop. */
2000 b->base.type = type;
2001 }
2002 }
2003 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
2004 {
2005 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2006 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2007 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2008 else
2009 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2010 "read/access watchpoint."));
2011 }
2012 else
2013 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2014
2015 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2016 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2017 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
2018 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2019 }
2020
2021 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
2022 {
2023 next = value_next (v);
2024 if (v != b->val)
2025 value_free (v);
2026 }
2027
2028 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2029 above left it without any location set up. But,
2030 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2031 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2032 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
2033 {
2034 struct breakpoint *base = &b->base;
2035 base->loc = allocate_bp_location (base);
2036 base->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2037 base->loc->address = -1;
2038 base->loc->length = -1;
2039 base->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
2040 }
2041 }
2042 else if (!within_current_scope)
2043 {
2044 printf_filtered (_("\
2045 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2046 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2047 b->base.number);
2048 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2049 }
2050
2051 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2052 if (frame_saved)
2053 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2054 }
2055
2056
2057 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2058 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2059 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2060 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2061 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2062 static int
2063 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2064 {
2065 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2066 return 0;
2067
2068 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2069 return 0;
2070
2071 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2072 return 0;
2073
2074 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2075 return 0;
2076
2077 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2078 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2079 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2080 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2081 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2082 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2083 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2084 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2085 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2086 return 0;
2087
2088 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2089 location. */
2090 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2091 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2092 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2093 bl->address))
2094 return 0;
2095
2096 return 1;
2097 }
2098
2099 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2100 that the location is not duplicated. */
2101
2102 static int
2103 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2104 {
2105 int result;
2106 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2107
2108 bl->duplicate = 0;
2109 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2110 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2111 return result;
2112 }
2113
2114 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2115 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2116 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2117 any error during parsing. */
2118
2119 static struct agent_expr *
2120 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2121 {
2122 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2123 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
2124
2125 if (!cond)
2126 return NULL;
2127
2128 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2129 that may show up. */
2130 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2131 {
2132 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2133 }
2134
2135 if (ex.reason < 0)
2136 {
2137 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2138 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2139 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2140 return NULL;
2141 }
2142
2143 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2144 return aexpr;
2145 }
2146
2147 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2148 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2149 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2150 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2151 one of them is true. */
2152
2153 static void
2154 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2155 {
2156 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2157 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2158 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2159 struct bp_location *loc;
2160
2161 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2162 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions);
2163
2164 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2165 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2166 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2167 side. */
2168 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2169 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2170 return;
2171
2172 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2173 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2174 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2175 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2176 response back to GDB. */
2177 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2178 {
2179 loc = (*loc2p);
2180 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2181 {
2182 if (modified)
2183 {
2184 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2185
2186 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2187 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2188 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2189 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2190 aexpr = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, loc->cond);
2191 loc->cond_bytecode = aexpr;
2192
2193 /* Check if we managed to parse the conditional expression
2194 correctly. If not, we will not send this condition
2195 to the target. */
2196 if (aexpr)
2197 continue;
2198 }
2199
2200 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2201 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2202 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2203 {
2204 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2205 break;
2206 }
2207 }
2208 }
2209
2210 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2211 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2212 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2213
2214 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2215 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2216 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2217 {
2218 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2219 {
2220 loc = (*loc2p);
2221 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2222 {
2223 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2224 located. */
2225 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2226 return;
2227
2228 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
2229 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
2230 }
2231 }
2232 }
2233
2234 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2235 for this location's address. */
2236 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2237 {
2238 loc = (*loc2p);
2239 if (loc->cond
2240 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2241 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2242 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2243 && loc->enabled)
2244 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later to send the
2245 conditions to the target. */
2246 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions,
2247 loc->cond_bytecode);
2248 }
2249
2250 return;
2251 }
2252
2253 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2254 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2255 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2256
2257 static struct agent_expr *
2258 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2259 {
2260 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2261 struct expression *expr, **argvec;
2262 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2263 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
2264 const char *cmdrest;
2265 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2266 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2267 int nargs;
2268 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2269
2270 if (!cmd)
2271 return NULL;
2272
2273 cmdrest = cmd;
2274
2275 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2276 ++cmdrest;
2277 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2278
2279 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2280 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2281
2282 format_start = cmdrest;
2283
2284 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2285
2286 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2287
2288 format_end = cmdrest;
2289
2290 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2291 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2292
2293 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2294
2295 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2296 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2297
2298 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2299 cmdrest++;
2300 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2301
2302 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2303
2304 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2305 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2306
2307 nargs = 0;
2308 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2309 {
2310 const char *cmd1;
2311
2312 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2313 expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2314 argvec[nargs++] = expr;
2315 cmdrest = cmd1;
2316 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2317 ++cmdrest;
2318 }
2319
2320 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2321 that may show up. */
2322 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2323 {
2324 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2325 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2326 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2327 }
2328
2329 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2330
2331 if (ex.reason < 0)
2332 {
2333 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2334 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2335 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2336 return NULL;
2337 }
2338
2339 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2340 return aexpr;
2341 }
2342
2343 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2344 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2345 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2346
2347 static void
2348 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2349 {
2350 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2351 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2352 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2353 struct bp_location *loc;
2354
2355 /* Release commands left over from a previous insert. */
2356 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands);
2357
2358 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2359 return;
2360
2361 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2362 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2363 return;
2364
2365 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2366 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2367 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2368 control. */
2369 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2370 {
2371 loc = (*loc2p);
2372 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2373 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2374 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2375 return;
2376 }
2377
2378 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2379 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2380 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2381 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2382 response back to GDB. */
2383 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2384 {
2385 loc = (*loc2p);
2386 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2387 {
2388 if (modified)
2389 {
2390 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2391
2392 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2393 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2394 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2395 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2396 aexpr = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2397 loc->owner->extra_string);
2398 loc->cmd_bytecode = aexpr;
2399
2400 if (!aexpr)
2401 continue;
2402 }
2403
2404 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2405 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2406 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2407 {
2408 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2409 break;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 }
2413
2414 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2415 and so clean up. */
2416 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2417 {
2418 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2419 {
2420 loc = (*loc2p);
2421 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2422 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2423 {
2424 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2425 located. */
2426 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2427 return;
2428
2429 free_agent_expr (loc->cmd_bytecode);
2430 loc->cmd_bytecode = NULL;
2431 }
2432 }
2433 }
2434
2435 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2436 for this location's address. */
2437 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2438 {
2439 loc = (*loc2p);
2440 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2441 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2442 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2443 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2444 && loc->enabled)
2445 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2446 to send the commands to the target. */
2447 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands,
2448 loc->cmd_bytecode);
2449 }
2450
2451 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2452 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2453 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2454 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2455 }
2456
2457 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2458 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2459 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2460 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2461 -1 for failure.
2462
2463 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2464 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2465 static int
2466 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2467 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2468 int *disabled_breaks,
2469 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2470 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2471 {
2472 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2473 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2474 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
2475
2476 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2477 return 0;
2478
2479 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2480 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2481 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2482 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2483 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2484 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2485 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2486 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2487 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2488 bl->target_info.placed_address = bl->address;
2489 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2490 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2491
2492 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2493 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2494 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2495 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2496
2497 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2498 {
2499 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2500 build_target_command_list (bl);
2501 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2502 bl->needs_update = 0;
2503 }
2504
2505 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2506 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2507 {
2508 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2509 {
2510 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2511 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2512 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2513
2514 Two important cases are:
2515 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2516 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2517 hardware breakpoint.
2518 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2519 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2520 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2521 so we undo.
2522
2523 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2524 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2525 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2526 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2527 gdb. */
2528 struct mem_region *mr
2529 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.placed_address);
2530
2531 if (mr)
2532 {
2533 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2534 {
2535 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2536
2537 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2538 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2539 else
2540 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2541
2542 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2543 {
2544 static int said = 0;
2545
2546 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2547 if (!said)
2548 {
2549 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2550 _("Note: automatically using "
2551 "hardware breakpoints for "
2552 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2553 said = 1;
2554 }
2555 }
2556 }
2557 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2558 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2559 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint "
2560 "at readonly address %s"),
2561 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2562 }
2563 }
2564
2565 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2566 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2567 || bl->section == NULL
2568 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2569 {
2570 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2571 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2572 {
2573 int val;
2574
2575 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2576 if (val)
2577 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2578 }
2579 if (e.reason < 0)
2580 {
2581 bp_err = e.error;
2582 bp_err_message = e.message;
2583 }
2584 }
2585 else
2586 {
2587 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2588 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2589 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2590 {
2591 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2592 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2593 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2594 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2595 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2596 bl->owner->number);
2597 else
2598 {
2599 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2600 bl->section);
2601 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2602 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2603 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2604
2605 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2606 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2607 {
2608 int val;
2609
2610 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2611 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2612 if (val)
2613 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2614 }
2615 if (e.reason < 0)
2616 {
2617 bp_err = e.error;
2618 bp_err_message = e.message;
2619 }
2620
2621 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2622 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2623 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2624 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2625 bl->owner->number);
2626 }
2627 }
2628 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2629 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2630 {
2631 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2632 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2633 {
2634 int val;
2635
2636 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2637 if (val)
2638 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2639 }
2640 if (e.reason < 0)
2641 {
2642 bp_err = e.error;
2643 bp_err_message = e.message;
2644 }
2645 }
2646 else
2647 {
2648 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2649 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2650 return 0;
2651 }
2652 }
2653
2654 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2655 {
2656 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2657
2658 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2659 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2660 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2661 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2662 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2663 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2664 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2665 errors as memory errors. */
2666 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2667 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2668 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2669 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2670 bl->address)))
2671 {
2672 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2673 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2674 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2675 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2676 {
2677 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2678 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2679 bl->owner->number);
2680 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2681 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2682 "library breakpoints:\n");
2683 }
2684 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2685 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2686 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2687 return 0;
2688 }
2689 else
2690 {
2691 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2692 {
2693 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2694 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2695 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2696 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2697 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2698 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2699 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2700 }
2701 else
2702 {
2703 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2704 {
2705 char *message
2706 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2707 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2708 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
2709
2710 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2711 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2712 "%s\n",
2713 bl->owner->number, message);
2714 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2715 }
2716 else
2717 {
2718 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2719 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2720 bl->owner->number,
2721 bp_err_message);
2722 }
2723 }
2724 return 1;
2725
2726 }
2727 }
2728 else
2729 bl->inserted = 1;
2730
2731 return 0;
2732 }
2733
2734 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2735 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2736 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2737 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2738 {
2739 int val;
2740
2741 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2742 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2743
2744 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2745
2746 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2747 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2748 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2749 {
2750 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2751
2752 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2753 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2754 of this one. */
2755 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2756 if (loc != bl
2757 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2758 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2759 {
2760 bl->duplicate = 1;
2761 bl->inserted = 1;
2762 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2763 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2764 val = 0;
2765 break;
2766 }
2767
2768 if (val == 1)
2769 {
2770 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2771 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2772
2773 if (val)
2774 /* Back to the original value. */
2775 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2776 }
2777 }
2778
2779 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2780 }
2781
2782 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2783 {
2784 int val;
2785
2786 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2787 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2788
2789 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2790 if (val)
2791 {
2792 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2793
2794 if (val == 1)
2795 warning (_("\
2796 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2797 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2798 else
2799 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2800 }
2801
2802 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2803
2804 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2805 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2806 so just return success. */
2807 return 0;
2808 }
2809
2810 return 0;
2811 }
2812
2813 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2814 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2815 PSPACE anymore. */
2816
2817 void
2818 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2819 {
2820 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2821 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2822
2823 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2824 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2825 {
2826 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2827 delete_breakpoint (b);
2828 }
2829
2830 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2831 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2832 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2833 {
2834 struct bp_location *tmp;
2835
2836 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2837 {
2838 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2839 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2840 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2841 else
2842 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2843 if (tmp->next == loc)
2844 {
2845 tmp->next = loc->next;
2846 break;
2847 }
2848 }
2849 }
2850
2851 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2852 removed locations above. */
2853 update_global_location_list (0);
2854 }
2855
2856 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2857 Throws exception on any error.
2858 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2859 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2860 void
2861 insert_breakpoints (void)
2862 {
2863 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2864
2865 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2866 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2867 {
2868 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2869
2870 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2871 }
2872
2873 update_global_location_list (1);
2874
2875 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
2876 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
2877 now. */
2878 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
2879 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
2880 }
2881
2882 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2883
2884 void
2885 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2886 {
2887 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2888
2889 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2890 {
2891 callback (loc, NULL);
2892 }
2893 }
2894
2895 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2896 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2897 always-inserted mode. */
2898
2899 static void
2900 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2901 {
2902 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2903 int error_flag = 0;
2904 int val = 0;
2905 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2906 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2907 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2908
2909 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2910 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2911
2912 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2913 there was an error. */
2914 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
2915
2916 save_current_space_and_thread ();
2917
2918 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2919 {
2920 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2921 breakpoints. */
2922 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2923 continue;
2924
2925 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2926 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2927 deletion of breakpoints. */
2928 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2929 continue;
2930
2931 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2932
2933 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2934 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2935 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2936 insert breakpoints. */
2937 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2938 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2939 continue;
2940
2941 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2942 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2943 if (val)
2944 error_flag = val;
2945 }
2946
2947 if (error_flag)
2948 {
2949 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
2950 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2951 }
2952
2953 do_cleanups (cleanups);
2954 }
2955
2956 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2957
2958 static void
2959 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2960 {
2961 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2962 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2963 int error_flag = 0;
2964 int val = 0;
2965 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2966 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2967 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2968
2969 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2970 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2971
2972 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2973 there was an error. */
2974 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
2975
2976 save_current_space_and_thread ();
2977
2978 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2979 {
2980 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2981 continue;
2982
2983 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2984 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2985 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2986 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2987 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2988 continue;
2989
2990 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2991
2992 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2993 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2994 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2995 insert breakpoints. */
2996 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2997 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2998 continue;
2999
3000 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3001 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3002 if (val)
3003 error_flag = val;
3004 }
3005
3006 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3007 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3008 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3009 {
3010 int some_failed = 0;
3011 struct bp_location *loc;
3012
3013 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3014 continue;
3015
3016 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3017 continue;
3018
3019 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3020 continue;
3021
3022 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3023 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3024 {
3025 some_failed = 1;
3026 break;
3027 }
3028 if (some_failed)
3029 {
3030 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3031 if (loc->inserted)
3032 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
3033
3034 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3035 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3036 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3037 bpt->number);
3038 error_flag = -1;
3039 }
3040 }
3041
3042 if (error_flag)
3043 {
3044 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3045 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3046 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3047 {
3048 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3049 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3050 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3051 }
3052 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3053 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3054 }
3055
3056 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3057 }
3058
3059 /* Used when the program stops.
3060 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3061 removing a breakpoint location. */
3062
3063 int
3064 remove_breakpoints (void)
3065 {
3066 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3067 int val = 0;
3068
3069 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3070 {
3071 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3072 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3073 }
3074 return val;
3075 }
3076
3077 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3078 that thread. */
3079
3080 static void
3081 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3082 {
3083 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3084
3085 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3086 {
3087 if (b->thread == tp->num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3088 {
3089 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3090
3091 printf_filtered (_("\
3092 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %d no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3093 b->number, tp->num);
3094
3095 /* Hide it from the user. */
3096 b->number = 0;
3097 }
3098 }
3099 }
3100
3101 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3102
3103 int
3104 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3105 {
3106 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3107 int val;
3108 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3109
3110 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3111 {
3112 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3113 continue;
3114
3115 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf)
3116 continue;
3117
3118 if (bl->inserted)
3119 {
3120 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3121 if (val != 0)
3122 return val;
3123 }
3124 }
3125 return 0;
3126 }
3127
3128 int
3129 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
3130 {
3131 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3132 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3133 int val;
3134 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
3135 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0;
3136 struct inferior *inf;
3137 struct thread_info *tp;
3138
3139 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
3140 if (tp == NULL)
3141 return 1;
3142
3143 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3144 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3145
3146 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
3147
3148 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3149 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3150
3151 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3152 {
3153 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3154 continue;
3155
3156 if (bl->inserted)
3157 {
3158 bl->inserted = 0;
3159 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3);
3160 if (val != 0)
3161 {
3162 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3163 return val;
3164 }
3165 }
3166 }
3167 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3168 return 0;
3169 }
3170
3171 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3172
3173 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3174 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3175 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3176 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3177 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3178 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3179 static void
3180 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3181 {
3182 if (internal)
3183 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3184 else
3185 {
3186 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3187 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3188 }
3189 }
3190
3191 static struct breakpoint *
3192 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3193 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3194 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3195 {
3196 struct symtab_and_line sal;
3197 struct breakpoint *b;
3198
3199 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
3200
3201 sal.pc = address;
3202 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3203 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3204
3205 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3206 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3207 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3208
3209 return b;
3210 }
3211
3212 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3213 {
3214 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3215 };
3216 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3217
3218 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3219 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3220 {
3221 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3222 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3223
3224 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3225 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3226
3227 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3228 int longjmp_searched;
3229
3230 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
3231 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
3232
3233 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3234 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3235
3236 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3237 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3238
3239 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3240 int exception_searched;
3241
3242 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
3243 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
3244 };
3245
3246 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3247
3248 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3249 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3250
3251 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3252
3253 static int
3254 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3255 {
3256 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3257 }
3258
3259 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3260 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3261
3262 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3263 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3264 {
3265 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3266
3267 bp_objfile_data = objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key);
3268 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3269 {
3270 bp_objfile_data = obstack_alloc (&objfile->objfile_obstack,
3271 sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3272
3273 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3274 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3275 }
3276 return bp_objfile_data;
3277 }
3278
3279 static void
3280 free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3281 {
3282 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data = data;
3283
3284 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
3285 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
3286 }
3287
3288 static void
3289 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3290 {
3291 struct objfile *objfile;
3292 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3293
3294 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3295 {
3296 struct breakpoint *b;
3297 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3298 CORE_ADDR addr;
3299
3300 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3301
3302 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3303 continue;
3304
3305 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3306 {
3307 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3308
3309 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3310 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3311 {
3312 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3313 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3314 continue;
3315 }
3316 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3317 }
3318
3319 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3320 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3321 bp_overlay_event,
3322 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3323 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3324
3325 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3326 {
3327 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3328 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3329 }
3330 else
3331 {
3332 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3333 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3334 }
3335 }
3336 update_global_location_list (1);
3337 }
3338
3339 static void
3340 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3341 {
3342 struct program_space *pspace;
3343 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3344
3345 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3346
3347 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3348 {
3349 struct objfile *objfile;
3350
3351 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3352
3353 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3354 {
3355 int i;
3356 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3357 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3358
3359 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3360
3361 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3362
3363 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3364 {
3365 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3366
3367 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3368 if (ret != NULL)
3369 {
3370 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3371 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3372
3373 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3374 {
3375 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3376 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3377 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3378 ret = NULL;
3379 }
3380 }
3381 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3382 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3383 }
3384
3385 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
3386 {
3387 int i;
3388 struct probe *probe;
3389 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3390
3391 for (i = 0;
3392 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3393 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
3394 i, probe);
3395 ++i)
3396 {
3397 struct breakpoint *b;
3398
3399 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3400 get_probe_address (probe,
3401 objfile),
3402 bp_longjmp_master,
3403 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3404 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3405 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3406 }
3407
3408 continue;
3409 }
3410
3411 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3412 continue;
3413
3414 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3415 {
3416 struct breakpoint *b;
3417 const char *func_name;
3418 CORE_ADDR addr;
3419
3420 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3421 continue;
3422
3423 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3424 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3425 {
3426 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3427
3428 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3429 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3430 {
3431 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3432 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3433 continue;
3434 }
3435 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3436 }
3437
3438 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3439 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3440 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3441 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3442 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3443 }
3444 }
3445 }
3446 update_global_location_list (1);
3447
3448 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3449 }
3450
3451 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3452 static void
3453 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3454 {
3455 struct program_space *pspace;
3456 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3457 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3458
3459 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3460
3461 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3462 {
3463 struct objfile *objfile;
3464 CORE_ADDR addr;
3465
3466 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3467
3468 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3469 {
3470 struct breakpoint *b;
3471 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3472
3473 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3474
3475 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3476 continue;
3477
3478 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3479 {
3480 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3481
3482 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3483 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3484 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3485 {
3486 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3487 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3488 continue;
3489 }
3490 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3491 }
3492
3493 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3494 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3495 bp_std_terminate_master,
3496 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3497 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3498 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3499 }
3500 }
3501
3502 update_global_location_list (1);
3503
3504 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3505 }
3506
3507 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3508
3509 static void
3510 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3511 {
3512 struct objfile *objfile;
3513 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3514
3515 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3516 {
3517 struct breakpoint *b;
3518 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3519 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3520 CORE_ADDR addr;
3521
3522 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3523
3524 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3525 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3526 {
3527 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3528
3529 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3530
3531 if (ret != NULL)
3532 {
3533 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3534 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3535
3536 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3537 {
3538 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3539 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3540 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3541 ret = NULL;
3542 }
3543 }
3544 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3545 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3546 }
3547
3548 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3549 {
3550 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3551 int i;
3552 struct probe *probe;
3553
3554 for (i = 0;
3555 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3556 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3557 i, probe);
3558 ++i)
3559 {
3560 struct breakpoint *b;
3561
3562 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3563 get_probe_address (probe,
3564 objfile),
3565 bp_exception_master,
3566 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3567 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3568 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3569 }
3570
3571 continue;
3572 }
3573
3574 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3575
3576 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3577 continue;
3578
3579 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3580
3581 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3582 {
3583 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3584
3585 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3586 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3587 {
3588 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3589 continue;
3590 }
3591
3592 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3593 }
3594
3595 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3596 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3597 &current_target);
3598 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3599 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3600 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3601 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3602 }
3603
3604 update_global_location_list (1);
3605 }
3606
3607 void
3608 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3609 {
3610 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3611 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3612
3613 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3614 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3615 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3616 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3617 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3618 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3619 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3620 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3621 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3622 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3623 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3624
3625 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3626 {
3627 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3628 continue;
3629
3630 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3631 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3632 {
3633 delete_breakpoint (b);
3634 continue;
3635 }
3636
3637 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3638 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3639 {
3640 delete_breakpoint (b);
3641 continue;
3642 }
3643
3644 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3645 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3646 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3647 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3648 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3649 {
3650 delete_breakpoint (b);
3651 continue;
3652 }
3653
3654 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3655 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3656 {
3657 delete_breakpoint (b);
3658 continue;
3659 }
3660
3661 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3662 after an exec. */
3663 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3664 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3665 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3666 {
3667 delete_breakpoint (b);
3668 continue;
3669 }
3670
3671 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3672 {
3673 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3674 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3675 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3676 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3677 continue;
3678 }
3679
3680 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3681 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3682 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3683 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3684 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3685 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3686
3687 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3688 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3689 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3690 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3691 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3692 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3693 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3694
3695 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3696 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3697 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3698 let finish_command delete it.
3699
3700 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3701 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3702 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3703 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3704 solib breakpoints.) */
3705
3706 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3707 {
3708 continue;
3709 }
3710
3711 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3712 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3713 a.out. */
3714 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
3715 {
3716 delete_breakpoint (b);
3717 continue;
3718 }
3719 }
3720 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
3721 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
3722 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
3723 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
3724 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
3725 }
3726
3727 int
3728 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3729 {
3730 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3731 int val = 0;
3732 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3733 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3734
3735 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3736 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3737
3738 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3739 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3740 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3741 {
3742 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3743 continue;
3744
3745 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3746 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3747 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3748 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3749 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3750 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3751 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3752 continue;
3753
3754 if (bl->inserted)
3755 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
3756 }
3757
3758 /* Detach single-step breakpoints as well. */
3759 detach_single_step_breakpoints ();
3760
3761 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3762 return val;
3763 }
3764
3765 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3766 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3767 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3768 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3769 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3770
3771 static int
3772 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3773 {
3774 int val;
3775
3776 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3777 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3778
3779 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
3780 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
3781 return 0;
3782
3783 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3784 This should not ever happen. */
3785 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3786
3787 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3788 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3789 {
3790 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3791 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3792 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3793
3794 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3795 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3796 || bl->section == NULL
3797 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3798 {
3799 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3800
3801 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3802 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3803 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3804 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3805 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3806 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3807 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3808 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3809 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3810 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3811 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3812 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3813 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3814 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3815 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3816 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3817 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3818 they should always be removed. */
3819 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3820 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3821 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3822 val = 0;
3823 else
3824 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3825 }
3826 else
3827 {
3828 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3829 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3830 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3831 {
3832 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3833 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3834 */
3835 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3836 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3837 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3838 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3839 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3840 else
3841 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3842 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3843 }
3844 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3845 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3846 if (bl->inserted)
3847 {
3848 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3849 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3850 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3851 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3852
3853 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3854 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3855 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3856 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3857 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3858 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3859 else
3860 val = 0;
3861 }
3862 else
3863 {
3864 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3865 val = 0;
3866 }
3867 }
3868
3869 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3870 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3871 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3872 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3873 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3874 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3875 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3876 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3877 always-inserted mode. */
3878 if (val
3879 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3880 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3881 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3882 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3883 bl->address))))
3884 val = 0;
3885
3886 if (val)
3887 return val;
3888 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3889 }
3890 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3891 {
3892 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3893 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3894
3895 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3896 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3897
3898 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3899 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
3900 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3901 bl->owner->number);
3902 }
3903 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3904 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3905 && !bl->duplicate)
3906 {
3907 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3908 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3909
3910 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3911 if (val)
3912 return val;
3913
3914 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3915 }
3916
3917 return 0;
3918 }
3919
3920 static int
3921 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3922 {
3923 int ret;
3924 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3925
3926 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3927 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3928
3929 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
3930 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
3931 return 0;
3932
3933 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3934 This should not ever happen. */
3935 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3936
3937 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
3938
3939 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3940
3941 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
3942
3943 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3944 return ret;
3945 }
3946
3947 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3948
3949 void
3950 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3951 {
3952 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3953
3954 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3955 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3956 bl->inserted = 0;
3957 }
3958
3959 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3960 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3961
3962 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3963 between runs.
3964
3965 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3966 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3967 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3968
3969
3970
3971 void
3972 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3973 {
3974 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3975 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3976 int ix;
3977 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3978
3979 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3980 nothing to do. */
3981 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3982 return;
3983
3984 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3985 {
3986 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3987 if (bl->pspace == pspace
3988 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3989 bl->inserted = 0;
3990 }
3991
3992 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3993 {
3994 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3995 continue;
3996
3997 switch (b->type)
3998 {
3999 case bp_call_dummy:
4000 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
4001
4002 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
4003 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
4004 rid of it. */
4005
4006 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4007
4008 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
4009
4010 case bp_shlib_event:
4011
4012 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
4013 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
4014 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
4015 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
4016 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
4017
4018 (gdb) file prog-linux
4019 (gdb) run # native linux target
4020 ...
4021 (gdb) kill
4022 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
4023 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
4024 */
4025
4026 case bp_step_resume:
4027
4028 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4029
4030 delete_breakpoint (b);
4031 break;
4032
4033 case bp_watchpoint:
4034 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4035 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4036 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4037 {
4038 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4039
4040 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4041 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4042 delete_breakpoint (b);
4043 else if (context == inf_starting)
4044 {
4045 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4046 insert_breakpoints. */
4047 if (w->val)
4048 value_free (w->val);
4049 w->val = NULL;
4050 w->val_valid = 0;
4051 }
4052 }
4053 break;
4054 default:
4055 break;
4056 }
4057 }
4058
4059 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4060 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4061 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4062 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4063 }
4064
4065 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4066 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4067 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4068 match, not program space. */
4069
4070 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4071 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4072 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4073 permanent breakpoint.
4074 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4075 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4076 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4077 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4078 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4079
4080 enum breakpoint_here
4081 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4082 {
4083 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4084 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4085
4086 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4087 {
4088 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4089 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4090 continue;
4091
4092 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4093 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4094 || bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
4095 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4096 {
4097 if (overlay_debugging
4098 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4099 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4100 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4101 else if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
4102 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4103 else
4104 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4105 }
4106 }
4107
4108 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
4109 }
4110
4111 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4112
4113 int
4114 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4115 {
4116 struct bp_location *loc;
4117 int ix;
4118
4119 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4120 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4121 return 1;
4122
4123 return 0;
4124 }
4125
4126 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
4127 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array
4128 mechanism. This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which
4129 are inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
4130
4131 int
4132 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4133 CORE_ADDR pc)
4134 {
4135 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4136
4137 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4138 {
4139 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4140 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4141 continue;
4142
4143 if (bl->inserted
4144 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4145 {
4146 if (overlay_debugging
4147 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4148 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4149 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4150 else
4151 return 1;
4152 }
4153 }
4154 return 0;
4155 }
4156
4157 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
4158 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4159
4160 int
4161 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4162 {
4163 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
4164 return 1;
4165
4166 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
4167 return 1;
4168
4169 return 0;
4170 }
4171
4172 /* Ignoring deprecated raw breakpoints, return non-zero iff there is a
4173 software breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4174
4175 static struct bp_location *
4176 find_non_raw_software_breakpoint_inserted_here (struct address_space *aspace,
4177 CORE_ADDR pc)
4178 {
4179 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4180
4181 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4182 {
4183 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4184 continue;
4185
4186 if (bl->inserted
4187 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4188 aspace, pc))
4189 {
4190 if (overlay_debugging
4191 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4192 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4193 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4194 else
4195 return bl;
4196 }
4197 }
4198
4199 return NULL;
4200 }
4201
4202 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4203 inserted at PC. */
4204
4205 int
4206 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4207 CORE_ADDR pc)
4208 {
4209 if (find_non_raw_software_breakpoint_inserted_here (aspace, pc) != NULL)
4210 return 1;
4211
4212 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
4213 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
4214 return 1;
4215
4216 return 0;
4217 }
4218
4219 int
4220 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
4221 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4222 {
4223 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4224
4225 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4226 {
4227 struct bp_location *loc;
4228
4229 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4230 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4231 continue;
4232
4233 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4234 continue;
4235
4236 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4237 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4238 {
4239 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4240
4241 /* Check for intersection. */
4242 l = max (loc->address, addr);
4243 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4244 if (l < h)
4245 return 1;
4246 }
4247 }
4248 return 0;
4249 }
4250
4251 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
4252 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
4253
4254 int
4255 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4256 ptid_t ptid)
4257 {
4258 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4259 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
4260 int thread = -1;
4261 int task = 0;
4262
4263 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4264 {
4265 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4266 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4267 continue;
4268
4269 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has bl->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4270 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4271 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4272 continue;
4273
4274 if (!breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4275 continue;
4276
4277 if (bl->owner->thread != -1)
4278 {
4279 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
4280 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
4281 it is now time to do so. */
4282 if (thread == -1)
4283 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
4284 if (bl->owner->thread != thread)
4285 continue;
4286 }
4287
4288 if (bl->owner->task != 0)
4289 {
4290 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
4291 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
4292 it is now time to do so. */
4293 if (task == 0)
4294 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
4295 if (bl->owner->task != task)
4296 continue;
4297 }
4298
4299 if (overlay_debugging
4300 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4301 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4302 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4303
4304 return 1;
4305 }
4306
4307 return 0;
4308 }
4309 \f
4310
4311 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4312 in breakpoint.h. */
4313
4314 int
4315 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4316 {
4317 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4318 }
4319
4320 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4321 'next' chain. */
4322
4323 static void
4324 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
4325 {
4326 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4327 value_free (bs->old_val);
4328 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4329 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
4330 xfree (bs);
4331 }
4332
4333 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4334 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4335
4336 void
4337 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4338 {
4339 bpstat p;
4340 bpstat q;
4341
4342 if (bsp == 0)
4343 return;
4344 p = *bsp;
4345 while (p != NULL)
4346 {
4347 q = p->next;
4348 bpstat_free (p);
4349 p = q;
4350 }
4351 *bsp = NULL;
4352 }
4353
4354 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4355 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4356
4357 bpstat
4358 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4359 {
4360 bpstat p = NULL;
4361 bpstat tmp;
4362 bpstat retval = NULL;
4363
4364 if (bs == NULL)
4365 return bs;
4366
4367 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4368 {
4369 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
4370 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
4371 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
4372 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
4373 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4374 {
4375 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
4376 release_value (tmp->old_val);
4377 }
4378
4379 if (p == NULL)
4380 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4381 retval = tmp;
4382 else
4383 p->next = tmp;
4384 p = tmp;
4385 }
4386 p->next = NULL;
4387 return retval;
4388 }
4389
4390 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4391
4392 bpstat
4393 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4394 {
4395 if (bsp == NULL)
4396 return NULL;
4397
4398 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4399 {
4400 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4401 return bsp;
4402 }
4403 return NULL;
4404 }
4405
4406 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4407
4408 int
4409 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4410 {
4411 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4412 {
4413 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4414 {
4415 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4416 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4417 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4418 return 1;
4419 }
4420 else
4421 {
4422 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4423 sig))
4424 return 1;
4425 }
4426 }
4427
4428 return 0;
4429 }
4430
4431 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4432 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4433 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4434 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4435
4436 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4437 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4438 we set it.
4439 Return 1 otherwise. */
4440
4441 int
4442 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4443 {
4444 struct breakpoint *b;
4445
4446 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4447 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4448
4449 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4450 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4451 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4452 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4453 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4454 if (b == NULL)
4455 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4456
4457 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4458 return 1;
4459 }
4460
4461 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4462
4463 void
4464 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4465 {
4466 struct thread_info *tp;
4467 bpstat bs;
4468
4469 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4470 return;
4471
4472 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4473 if (tp == NULL)
4474 return;
4475
4476 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4477 {
4478 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4479
4480 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4481 {
4482 value_free (bs->old_val);
4483 bs->old_val = NULL;
4484 }
4485 }
4486 }
4487
4488 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4489
4490 static void
4491 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4492 {
4493 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4494 {
4495 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4496
4497 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4498 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4499 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4500 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4501 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4502 return;
4503 }
4504
4505 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4506 }
4507
4508 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
4509 command. */
4510 static void
4511 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
4512 {
4513 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
4514 }
4515
4516 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4517 or its equivalent. */
4518
4519 static int
4520 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4521 {
4522 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0
4523 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q", cmd->line) == 0));
4524 }
4525
4526 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4527 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4528 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4529 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4530
4531 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4532 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4533 bpstat of the current thread. */
4534
4535 static int
4536 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4537 {
4538 bpstat bs;
4539 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4540 int again = 0;
4541
4542 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4543 in bs->commands. */
4544 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4545 return 0;
4546
4547 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4548 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4549
4550 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4551
4552 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4553 bs = *bsp;
4554
4555 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4556 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4557 {
4558 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4559 struct command_line *cmd;
4560 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4561
4562 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4563
4564 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4565 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4566 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4567 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4568 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4569 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4570 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4571 the tree when we're done. */
4572 ccmd = bs->commands;
4573 bs->commands = NULL;
4574 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4575 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4576 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4577 {
4578 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4579 cmd = cmd->next;
4580 }
4581
4582 while (cmd != NULL)
4583 {
4584 execute_control_command (cmd);
4585
4586 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4587 break;
4588 else
4589 cmd = cmd->next;
4590 }
4591
4592 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4593 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4594
4595 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4596 {
4597 if (target_can_async_p ())
4598 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4599 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4600 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4601 ;
4602 else
4603 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4604 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4605 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4606 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4607 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4608 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4609 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4610 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4611 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4612 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4613 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4614 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4615 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4616 again = 1;
4617 break;
4618 }
4619 }
4620 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4621 return again;
4622 }
4623
4624 void
4625 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4626 {
4627 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4628
4629 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4630 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4631 && target_has_execution
4632 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4633 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4634 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4635 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4636 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4637 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4638 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4639 break;
4640
4641 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4642 }
4643
4644 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4645
4646 static void
4647 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4648 {
4649 if (val == NULL)
4650 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4651 else
4652 {
4653 struct value_print_options opts;
4654 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4655 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4656 }
4657 }
4658
4659 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4660 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4661 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4662 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4663 normal_stop(). */
4664
4665 static enum print_stop_action
4666 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4667 {
4668 switch (bs->print_it)
4669 {
4670 case print_it_noop:
4671 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4672 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4673 break;
4674
4675 case print_it_done:
4676 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4677 relevant messages. */
4678 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4679 break;
4680
4681 case print_it_normal:
4682 {
4683 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4684
4685 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4686 which has since been deleted. */
4687 if (b == NULL)
4688 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4689
4690 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4691 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4692 }
4693 break;
4694
4695 default:
4696 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4697 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4698 break;
4699 }
4700 }
4701
4702 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4703
4704 static void
4705 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4706 {
4707 int any_deleted
4708 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4709 int any_added
4710 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4711
4712 if (!is_catchpoint)
4713 {
4714 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4715 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4716 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4717 else
4718 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4719 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4720 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4721 }
4722
4723 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4724 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4725 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4726
4727 if (any_deleted)
4728 {
4729 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4730 char *name;
4731 int ix;
4732
4733 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4734 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4735 "removed");
4736 for (ix = 0;
4737 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4738 ix, name);
4739 ++ix)
4740 {
4741 if (ix > 0)
4742 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4743 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4744 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4745 }
4746
4747 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4748 }
4749
4750 if (any_added)
4751 {
4752 struct so_list *iter;
4753 int ix;
4754 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4755
4756 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4757 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4758 "added");
4759 for (ix = 0;
4760 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4761 ix, iter);
4762 ++ix)
4763 {
4764 if (ix > 0)
4765 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4766 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4767 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4768 }
4769
4770 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4771 }
4772 }
4773
4774 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4775 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4776 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4777 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4778 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4779 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4780 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4781 routine is one of:
4782
4783 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4784 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4785 code to print the location. An example is
4786 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4787 the location.
4788 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4789 to also print the location part of the message.
4790 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4791 don't require a location appended to the end.
4792 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4793 further info to be printed. */
4794
4795 enum print_stop_action
4796 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4797 {
4798 int val;
4799
4800 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4801 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4802 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4803 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4804 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4805 {
4806 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4807 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4808 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4809 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4810 return val;
4811 }
4812
4813 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4814 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4815 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4816 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4817 {
4818 print_solib_event (0);
4819 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4820 }
4821
4822 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4823 with and nothing was printed. */
4824 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4825 }
4826
4827 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
4828 This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called
4829 from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an
4830 exception happens we want execution to stop.
4831 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
4832 "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
4833
4834 static int
4835 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
4836 {
4837 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4838 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
4839
4840 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4841 return i;
4842 }
4843
4844 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4845
4846 static bpstat
4847 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4848 {
4849 bpstat bs;
4850
4851 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
4852 bs->next = NULL;
4853 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
4854 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
4855 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
4856 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
4857 incref_bp_location (bl);
4858 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
4859 bs->commands = NULL;
4860 bs->old_val = NULL;
4861 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
4862 return bs;
4863 }
4864 \f
4865 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4866 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4867
4868 int
4869 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4870 {
4871 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4872 CORE_ADDR addr;
4873 struct breakpoint *b;
4874
4875 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4876 {
4877 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4878 as not triggered. */
4879 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4880 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4881 {
4882 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4883
4884 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4885 }
4886
4887 return 0;
4888 }
4889
4890 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4891 {
4892 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4893 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4894 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4895 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4896 {
4897 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4898
4899 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4900 }
4901
4902 return 1;
4903 }
4904
4905 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4906 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4907 triggered. */
4908
4909 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4910 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4911 {
4912 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4913 struct bp_location *loc;
4914
4915 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4916 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4917 {
4918 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4919 {
4920 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4921 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4922
4923 if (newaddr == start)
4924 {
4925 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4926 break;
4927 }
4928 }
4929 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4930 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
4931 addr, loc->address,
4932 loc->length))
4933 {
4934 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4935 break;
4936 }
4937 }
4938 }
4939
4940 return 1;
4941 }
4942
4943 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
4944 because of check_errors). */
4945 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4946 #define WP_DELETED 1
4947 /* The value has changed. */
4948 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
4949 /* The value has not changed. */
4950 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
4951 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4952 #define WP_IGNORE 4
4953
4954 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4955 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4956
4957 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4958 changed.
4959
4960 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
4961 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
4962
4963 static int
4964 watchpoint_check (void *p)
4965 {
4966 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
4967 struct watchpoint *b;
4968 struct frame_info *fr;
4969 int within_current_scope;
4970
4971 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4972 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4973 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4974
4975 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4976 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4977 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4978 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4979 return WP_IGNORE;
4980
4981 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4982 within_current_scope = 1;
4983 else
4984 {
4985 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4986 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4987 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4988
4989 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4990 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4991 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4992 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4993 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4994 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4995 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4996 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4997 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4998 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4999 return WP_IGNORE;
5000
5001 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
5002 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
5003
5004 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
5005 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
5006 if (within_current_scope)
5007 {
5008 struct symbol *function;
5009
5010 function = get_frame_function (fr);
5011 if (function == NULL
5012 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
5013 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
5014 within_current_scope = 0;
5015 }
5016
5017 if (within_current_scope)
5018 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
5019 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
5020 the user. */
5021 select_frame (fr);
5022 }
5023
5024 if (within_current_scope)
5025 {
5026 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
5027 time before we return to the command level and call
5028 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
5029 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
5030
5031 int pc = 0;
5032 struct value *mark;
5033 struct value *new_val;
5034
5035 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
5036 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
5037 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
5038 a mask watchpoint. */
5039 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5040
5041 mark = value_mark ();
5042 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
5043
5044 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
5045 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
5046 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
5047 not what we want. */
5048 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
5049 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
5050 {
5051 if (new_val != NULL)
5052 {
5053 release_value (new_val);
5054 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5055 }
5056 bs->old_val = b->val;
5057 b->val = new_val;
5058 b->val_valid = 1;
5059 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5060 }
5061 else
5062 {
5063 /* Nothing changed. */
5064 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5065 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
5066 }
5067 }
5068 else
5069 {
5070 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5071
5072 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5073 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5074 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5075 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5076 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5077 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5078 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5079 the first value assigned). */
5080 /* We print all the stop information in
5081 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5082 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5083 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5084 here. */
5085 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5086 ui_out_field_string
5087 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5088 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
5089 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
5090 ui_out_text (uiout,
5091 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
5092 which its expression is valid.\n");
5093
5094 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5095 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
5096 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5097
5098 return WP_DELETED;
5099 }
5100 }
5101
5102 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5103 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5104 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5105
5106 static int
5107 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5108 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5109 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5110 {
5111 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5112
5113 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5114 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5115
5116 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5117 }
5118
5119 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5120 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5121
5122 static void
5123 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5124 {
5125 const struct bp_location *bl;
5126 struct watchpoint *b;
5127
5128 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5129 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5130 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5131 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5132 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5133
5134 {
5135 int must_check_value = 0;
5136
5137 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5138 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5139 watched value. */
5140 must_check_value = 1;
5141 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5142 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5143 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5144 this watchpoint. */
5145 must_check_value = 1;
5146 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5147 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5148 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5149 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5150 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5151 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5152 must_check_value = 1;
5153
5154 if (must_check_value)
5155 {
5156 char *message
5157 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
5158 b->base.number);
5159 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
5160 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
5161 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5162 do_cleanups (cleanups);
5163 switch (e)
5164 {
5165 case WP_DELETED:
5166 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5167 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5168 /* Stop. */
5169 break;
5170 case WP_IGNORE:
5171 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5172 bs->stop = 0;
5173 break;
5174 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5175 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5176 {
5177 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5178
5179 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5180 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5181 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5182 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5183 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5184 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5185 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5186 old value.
5187
5188 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5189 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5190 happen:
5191
5192 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5193 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5194 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5195 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5196
5197 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5198 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5199 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5200 watchpoint.
5201
5202 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5203 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5204 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5205 changes. This still gives false positives when
5206 the program writes the same value to memory as
5207 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5208 it for a read), but it's much better than
5209 nothing. */
5210
5211 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5212
5213 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5214 {
5215 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5216
5217 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5218 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5219 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5220 {
5221 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5222 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5223
5224 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5225 == watch_triggered_yes)
5226 {
5227 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5228 break;
5229 }
5230 }
5231 }
5232
5233 if (other_write_watchpoint
5234 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5235 {
5236 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5237 and the value changed since the last time we
5238 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5239 Ignore it. */
5240 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5241 bs->stop = 0;
5242 }
5243 }
5244 break;
5245 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5246 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5247 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5248 {
5249 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5250 the value hasn't changed. */
5251 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5252 bs->stop = 0;
5253 }
5254 /* Stop. */
5255 break;
5256 default:
5257 /* Can't happen. */
5258 case 0:
5259 /* Error from catch_errors. */
5260 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->base.number);
5261 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5262 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5263 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5264 break;
5265 }
5266 }
5267 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5268 {
5269 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5270 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5271 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5272 anything for this watchpoint. */
5273 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5274 bs->stop = 0;
5275 }
5276 }
5277 }
5278
5279 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5280 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5281 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5282 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5283
5284 static void
5285 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5286 {
5287 const struct bp_location *bl;
5288 struct breakpoint *b;
5289 int value_is_zero = 0;
5290 struct expression *cond;
5291
5292 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5293
5294 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5295 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5296 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5297 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5298 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5299
5300 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5301 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5302 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5303
5304 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5305 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5306 {
5307 bs->stop = 0;
5308 return;
5309 }
5310
5311 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5312 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5313 thread/task. */
5314 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != pid_to_thread_id (ptid))
5315 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5316
5317 {
5318 bs->stop = 0;
5319 return;
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5323 implemented. */
5324 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5325
5326 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5327 {
5328 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5329
5330 cond = w->cond_exp;
5331 }
5332 else
5333 cond = bl->cond;
5334
5335 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5336 {
5337 int within_current_scope = 1;
5338 struct watchpoint * w;
5339
5340 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5341 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5342 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5343 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5344 function call. */
5345 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5346
5347 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5348 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5349 else
5350 w = NULL;
5351
5352 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5353 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5354 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5355 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5356 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5357 call site. */
5358 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5359 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5360 else
5361 {
5362 struct frame_info *frame;
5363
5364 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5365 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5366 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5367 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5368 really matter which instantiation of the function
5369 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5370 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5371 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5372 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5373 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5374 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5375 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5376 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5377 intuitive. */
5378 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5379 if (frame != NULL)
5380 select_frame (frame);
5381 else
5382 within_current_scope = 0;
5383 }
5384 if (within_current_scope)
5385 value_is_zero
5386 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
5387 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
5388 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5389 else
5390 {
5391 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5392 "in the current scope"));
5393 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5394 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5395 value_is_zero = 0;
5396 }
5397 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5398 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5399 }
5400
5401 if (cond && value_is_zero)
5402 {
5403 bs->stop = 0;
5404 }
5405 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5406 {
5407 b->ignore_count--;
5408 bs->stop = 0;
5409 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5410 ++(b->hit_count);
5411 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5412 }
5413 }
5414
5415
5416 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5417 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5418
5419 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5420 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5421 that:
5422
5423 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5424
5425 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5426
5427 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5428 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5429 several reasons concurrently.)
5430
5431 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5432 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5433
5434 bpstat
5435 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
5436 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5437 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5438 {
5439 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5440 struct bp_location *bl;
5441 struct bp_location *loc;
5442 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5443 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5444 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5445 bpstat bs;
5446 int ix;
5447 int need_remove_insert;
5448 int removed_any;
5449
5450 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5451 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5452 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5453 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5454 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5455 inferior function calls. */
5456
5457 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5458 {
5459 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
5460 continue;
5461
5462 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5463 {
5464 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5465 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5466 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5467 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5468 checked all locations already. */
5469 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5470 break;
5471
5472 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5473 continue;
5474
5475 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5476 continue;
5477
5478 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5479 matches. */
5480
5481 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5482 explain stop. */
5483
5484 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5485 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5486 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5487 bs->stop = 1;
5488 bs->print = 1;
5489
5490 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5491 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5492 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5493 iteration. */
5494 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5495 {
5496 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5497
5498 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5499 }
5500 }
5501 }
5502
5503 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5504 {
5505 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr))
5506 {
5507 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
5508 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5509 bs->stop = 0;
5510 bs->print = 0;
5511 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5512 }
5513 }
5514
5515 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5516 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5517 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5518 "catch unload". */
5519 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5520 {
5521 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5522 {
5523 handle_solib_event ();
5524 break;
5525 }
5526 }
5527
5528 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5529 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5530 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5531
5532 removed_any = 0;
5533
5534 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5535 {
5536 if (!bs->stop)
5537 continue;
5538
5539 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5540 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5541 if (bs->stop)
5542 {
5543 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5544
5545 if (bs->stop)
5546 {
5547 ++(b->hit_count);
5548 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5549
5550 /* We will stop here. */
5551 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5552 {
5553 --(b->enable_count);
5554 if (b->enable_count <= 0
5555 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
5556 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5557 removed_any = 1;
5558 }
5559 if (b->silent)
5560 bs->print = 0;
5561 bs->commands = b->commands;
5562 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5563 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5564 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5565 bs->print = 0;
5566
5567 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5568 }
5569
5570 }
5571
5572 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5573 print. */
5574 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5575 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5576 }
5577
5578 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5579 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5580 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5581 done later. */
5582 need_remove_insert = 0;
5583 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5584 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5585 if (!bs->stop
5586 && bs->breakpoint_at
5587 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5588 {
5589 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5590
5591 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5592 need_remove_insert = 1;
5593 }
5594
5595 if (need_remove_insert)
5596 update_global_location_list (1);
5597 else if (removed_any)
5598 update_global_location_list (0);
5599
5600 return bs_head;
5601 }
5602
5603 static void
5604 handle_jit_event (void)
5605 {
5606 struct frame_info *frame;
5607 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5608
5609 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5610 breakpoint_re_set. */
5611 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5612
5613 frame = get_current_frame ();
5614 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5615
5616 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5617
5618 target_terminal_inferior ();
5619 }
5620
5621 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5622
5623 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5624
5625 struct bpstat_what
5626 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5627 {
5628 struct bpstat_what retval;
5629 int jit_event = 0;
5630 bpstat bs;
5631
5632 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5633 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5634 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5635
5636 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5637 {
5638 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5639 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5640 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5641 enum bptype bptype;
5642
5643 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5644 {
5645 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5646 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5647 bptype = bp_none;
5648 }
5649 else
5650 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5651
5652 switch (bptype)
5653 {
5654 case bp_none:
5655 break;
5656 case bp_breakpoint:
5657 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5658 case bp_until:
5659 case bp_finish:
5660 case bp_shlib_event:
5661 if (bs->stop)
5662 {
5663 if (bs->print)
5664 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5665 else
5666 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5667 }
5668 else
5669 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5670 break;
5671 case bp_watchpoint:
5672 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5673 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5674 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5675 if (bs->stop)
5676 {
5677 if (bs->print)
5678 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5679 else
5680 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5681 }
5682 else
5683 {
5684 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5685 This requires no further action. */
5686 }
5687 break;
5688 case bp_longjmp:
5689 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5690 case bp_exception:
5691 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5692 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5693 break;
5694 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5695 case bp_exception_resume:
5696 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5697 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5698 break;
5699 case bp_step_resume:
5700 if (bs->stop)
5701 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5702 else
5703 {
5704 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5705 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5706 }
5707 break;
5708 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5709 if (bs->stop)
5710 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5711 else
5712 {
5713 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5714 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5715 }
5716 break;
5717 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5718 case bp_thread_event:
5719 case bp_overlay_event:
5720 case bp_longjmp_master:
5721 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5722 case bp_exception_master:
5723 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5724 break;
5725 case bp_catchpoint:
5726 if (bs->stop)
5727 {
5728 if (bs->print)
5729 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5730 else
5731 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5732 }
5733 else
5734 {
5735 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5736 This requires no further action. */
5737 }
5738 break;
5739 case bp_jit_event:
5740 jit_event = 1;
5741 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5742 break;
5743 case bp_call_dummy:
5744 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5745 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5746 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5747 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5748 break;
5749 case bp_std_terminate:
5750 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5751 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5752 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5753 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5754 break;
5755 case bp_tracepoint:
5756 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5757 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5758 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5759 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5760 out already. */
5761 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5762 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5763 break;
5764 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5765 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5766 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5767 break;
5768 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5769 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5770 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5771 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5772 break;
5773
5774 case bp_dprintf:
5775 if (bs->stop)
5776 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5777 else
5778 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5779 break;
5780
5781 default:
5782 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5783 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5784 }
5785
5786 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5787 }
5788
5789 /* These operations may affect the bs->breakpoint_at state so they are
5790 delayed after MAIN_ACTION is decided above. */
5791
5792 if (jit_event)
5793 {
5794 if (debug_infrun)
5795 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
5796
5797 handle_jit_event ();
5798 }
5799
5800 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5801 {
5802 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5803
5804 if (b == NULL)
5805 continue;
5806 switch (b->type)
5807 {
5808 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5809 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5810 break;
5811 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5812 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5813 break;
5814 }
5815 }
5816
5817 return retval;
5818 }
5819
5820 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5821 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5822 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5823
5824 int
5825 bpstat_should_step (void)
5826 {
5827 struct breakpoint *b;
5828
5829 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5830 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5831 return 1;
5832 return 0;
5833 }
5834
5835 int
5836 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5837 {
5838 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5839 if (bs->stop)
5840 return 1;
5841
5842 return 0;
5843 }
5844
5845 \f
5846
5847 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5848 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5849 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5850
5851 static char *
5852 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5853 {
5854 static char wrap_indent[80];
5855 int i, total_width, width, align;
5856 char *text;
5857
5858 total_width = 0;
5859 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5860 {
5861 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5862 {
5863 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5864 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5865 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5866
5867 return wrap_indent;
5868 }
5869
5870 total_width += width + 1;
5871 }
5872
5873 return NULL;
5874 }
5875
5876 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5877 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5878
5879 "host": Host evals condition.
5880 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5881 "target": Target evals condition.
5882 */
5883
5884 static const char *
5885 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5886 {
5887 struct bp_location *bl;
5888 char host_evals = 0;
5889 char target_evals = 0;
5890
5891 if (!b)
5892 return NULL;
5893
5894 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5895 return NULL;
5896
5897 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5898 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5899 return condition_evaluation_host;
5900
5901 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5902 {
5903 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5904 target_evals++;
5905 else
5906 host_evals++;
5907 }
5908
5909 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5910 return condition_evaluation_both;
5911 else if (target_evals)
5912 return condition_evaluation_target;
5913 else
5914 return condition_evaluation_host;
5915 }
5916
5917 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5918 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5919
5920 static const char *
5921 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5922 {
5923 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5924 return NULL;
5925
5926 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5927 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5928 return condition_evaluation_host;
5929
5930 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5931 return condition_evaluation_target;
5932 else
5933 return condition_evaluation_host;
5934 }
5935
5936 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5937
5938 static void
5939 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5940 struct bp_location *loc)
5941 {
5942 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5943 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
5944
5945 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5946 loc = NULL;
5947
5948 if (loc != NULL)
5949 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5950
5951 if (b->display_canonical)
5952 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->addr_string);
5953 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5954 {
5955 struct symbol *sym
5956 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
5957 if (sym)
5958 {
5959 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
5960 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
5961 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5962 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
5963 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5964 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
5965 }
5966 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
5967 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5968 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
5969
5970 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5971 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname",
5972 symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5973
5974 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
5975 }
5976 else if (loc)
5977 {
5978 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
5979 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
5980
5981 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
5982 demangle, "");
5983 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
5984
5985 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
5986 }
5987 else
5988 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
5989
5990 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5991 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5992 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5993 {
5994 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
5995 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
5996 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5997 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
5998 }
5999
6000 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6001 }
6002
6003 static const char *
6004 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
6005 {
6006 struct ep_type_description
6007 {
6008 enum bptype type;
6009 char *description;
6010 };
6011 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6012 {
6013 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6014 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6015 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6016 {bp_until, "until"},
6017 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6018 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6019 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6020 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6021 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6022 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6023 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6024 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6025 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6026 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6027 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6028 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6029 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6030 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6031 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6032 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6033 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6034 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6035 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6036 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6037 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6038 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6039 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6040 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6041 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6042 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6043 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6044 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6045 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6046 };
6047
6048 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6049 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6050 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6051 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6052 (int) type);
6053
6054 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6055 }
6056
6057 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6058 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6059
6060 static void
6061 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6062 const char *field_name,
6063 VEC(int) *inf_num,
6064 int mi_only)
6065 {
6066 struct cleanup *back_to;
6067 int is_mi = ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout);
6068 int inf;
6069 int i;
6070
6071 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6072 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6073 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6074 return;
6075
6076 back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name);
6077
6078 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6079 {
6080 if (is_mi)
6081 {
6082 char mi_group[10];
6083
6084 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6085 ui_out_field_string (uiout, NULL, mi_group);
6086 }
6087 else
6088 {
6089 if (i == 0)
6090 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
6091 else
6092 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
6093
6094 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf));
6095 }
6096 }
6097
6098 do_cleanups (back_to);
6099 }
6100
6101 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6102
6103 static void
6104 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6105 struct bp_location *loc,
6106 int loc_number,
6107 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6108 int allflag)
6109 {
6110 struct command_line *l;
6111 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6112
6113 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6114 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6115 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6116 struct value_print_options opts;
6117
6118 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6119
6120 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6121 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6122 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6123 if (loc == NULL
6124 && (b->loc != NULL
6125 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6126 header_of_multiple = 1;
6127 if (loc == NULL)
6128 loc = b->loc;
6129
6130 annotate_record ();
6131
6132 /* 1 */
6133 annotate_field (0);
6134 if (part_of_multiple)
6135 {
6136 char *formatted;
6137 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6138 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
6139 xfree (formatted);
6140 }
6141 else
6142 {
6143 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6144 }
6145
6146 /* 2 */
6147 annotate_field (1);
6148 if (part_of_multiple)
6149 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
6150 else
6151 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
6152
6153 /* 3 */
6154 annotate_field (2);
6155 if (part_of_multiple)
6156 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
6157 else
6158 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6159
6160
6161 /* 4 */
6162 annotate_field (3);
6163 if (part_of_multiple)
6164 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6165 else
6166 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
6167 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6168 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
6169
6170
6171 /* 5 and 6 */
6172 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6173 {
6174 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6175 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6176 make sure there's just one location. */
6177 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6178 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6179 }
6180 else
6181 switch (b->type)
6182 {
6183 case bp_none:
6184 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6185 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6186 break;
6187
6188 case bp_watchpoint:
6189 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6190 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6191 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6192 {
6193 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6194
6195 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6196 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6197 is relatively readable). */
6198 if (opts.addressprint)
6199 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6200 annotate_field (5);
6201 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
6202 }
6203 break;
6204
6205 case bp_breakpoint:
6206 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6207 case bp_until:
6208 case bp_finish:
6209 case bp_longjmp:
6210 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6211 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6212 case bp_exception:
6213 case bp_exception_resume:
6214 case bp_step_resume:
6215 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6216 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6217 case bp_call_dummy:
6218 case bp_std_terminate:
6219 case bp_shlib_event:
6220 case bp_thread_event:
6221 case bp_overlay_event:
6222 case bp_longjmp_master:
6223 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6224 case bp_exception_master:
6225 case bp_tracepoint:
6226 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6227 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6228 case bp_dprintf:
6229 case bp_jit_event:
6230 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6231 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6232 if (opts.addressprint)
6233 {
6234 annotate_field (4);
6235 if (header_of_multiple)
6236 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6237 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6238 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
6239 else
6240 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
6241 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6242 }
6243 annotate_field (5);
6244 if (!header_of_multiple)
6245 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6246 if (b->loc)
6247 *last_loc = b->loc;
6248 break;
6249 }
6250
6251
6252 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6253 {
6254 struct inferior *inf;
6255 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6256 int mi_only = 1;
6257
6258 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6259 {
6260 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6261 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6262 }
6263
6264 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6265 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6266 if (allflag
6267 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6268 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6269 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6270 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6271 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6272 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6273 mi_only = 0;
6274 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6275 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6276 }
6277
6278 if (!part_of_multiple)
6279 {
6280 if (b->thread != -1)
6281 {
6282 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6283 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6284 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
6285 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6286 }
6287 else if (b->task != 0)
6288 {
6289 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
6290 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
6291 }
6292 }
6293
6294 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6295
6296 if (!part_of_multiple)
6297 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6298
6299 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6300 {
6301 annotate_field (6);
6302 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6303 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6304 the frame ID. */
6305 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
6306 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6307 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6308 }
6309
6310 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6311 {
6312 annotate_field (7);
6313 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6314 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
6315 else
6316 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
6317 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
6318
6319 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6320 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6321 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6322 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6323 == condition_evaluation_target)
6324 {
6325 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6326 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6327 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6328 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
6329 }
6330 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6331 }
6332
6333 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6334 {
6335 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6336 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
6337 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6338 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6339 }
6340
6341 if (!part_of_multiple)
6342 {
6343 if (b->hit_count)
6344 {
6345 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6346 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6347 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
6348 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6349 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
6350 else
6351 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
6352 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
6353 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6354 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6355 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
6356 else
6357 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
6358 }
6359 else
6360 {
6361 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6362 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6363 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6364 }
6365 }
6366
6367 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6368 {
6369 annotate_field (8);
6370 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
6371 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
6372 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6373 }
6374
6375 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6376 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6377 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6378 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6379 {
6380 annotate_field (8);
6381 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
6382 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6383 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6384 if (b->ignore_count)
6385 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
6386 else
6387 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
6388 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
6389 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6390 }
6391
6392 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6393 {
6394 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6395
6396 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6397 {
6398 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
6399 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6400 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
6401 }
6402 }
6403
6404 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
6405 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6406 {
6407 struct cleanup *script_chain;
6408
6409 annotate_field (9);
6410 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
6411 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6412 do_cleanups (script_chain);
6413 }
6414
6415 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6416 {
6417 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6418
6419 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6420 {
6421 annotate_field (10);
6422 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
6423 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
6424 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6425 }
6426
6427 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6428 pending. */
6429 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6430 {
6431 annotate_field (11);
6432
6433 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6434 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "installed",
6435 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6436 else
6437 {
6438 if (loc->inserted)
6439 ui_out_text (uiout, "\t");
6440 else
6441 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tnot ");
6442 ui_out_text (uiout, "installed on target\n");
6443 }
6444 }
6445 }
6446
6447 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
6448 {
6449 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6450 {
6451 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6452
6453 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
6454 }
6455 else if (b->addr_string)
6456 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
6457 }
6458 }
6459
6460 static void
6461 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6462 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6463 int allflag)
6464 {
6465 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
6466 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6467
6468 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
6469
6470 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6471 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6472
6473 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6474 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6475 locations, if any. */
6476 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6477 {
6478 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6479 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6480 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6481 situation.
6482
6483 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6484 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6485 if (b->loc
6486 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6487 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6488 {
6489 struct bp_location *loc;
6490 int n = 1;
6491
6492 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6493 {
6494 struct cleanup *inner2 =
6495 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
6496 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6497 do_cleanups (inner2);
6498 }
6499 }
6500 }
6501 }
6502
6503 static int
6504 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6505 {
6506 int print_address_bits = 0;
6507 struct bp_location *loc;
6508
6509 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6510 {
6511 int addr_bit;
6512
6513 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
6514 an address to print. */
6515 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
6516 continue;
6517
6518 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6519 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6520 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6521 }
6522
6523 return print_address_bits;
6524 }
6525
6526 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
6527 {
6528 int bnum;
6529 };
6530
6531 static int
6532 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
6533 {
6534 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
6535 struct breakpoint *b;
6536 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6537
6538 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6539 {
6540 if (args->bnum == b->number)
6541 {
6542 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6543 return GDB_RC_OK;
6544 }
6545 }
6546 return GDB_RC_NONE;
6547 }
6548
6549 enum gdb_rc
6550 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
6551 char **error_message)
6552 {
6553 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
6554
6555 args.bnum = bnum;
6556 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
6557 an error. */
6558 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
6559 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
6560 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
6561 else
6562 return GDB_RC_OK;
6563 }
6564
6565 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6566 internal or momentary. */
6567
6568 int
6569 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6570 {
6571 return b->number > 0;
6572 }
6573
6574 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6575 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6576 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6577 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6578 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6579 breakpoints listed. */
6580
6581 static int
6582 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
6583 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6584 {
6585 struct breakpoint *b;
6586 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6587 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6588 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6589 struct value_print_options opts;
6590 int print_address_bits = 0;
6591 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6592 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6593
6594 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6595
6596 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6597 required for address fields. */
6598 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6599 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6600 {
6601 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6602 if (filter && !filter (b))
6603 continue;
6604
6605 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6606 accept. Skip the others. */
6607 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6608 {
6609 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6610 continue;
6611 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6612 continue;
6613 }
6614
6615 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6616 {
6617 int addr_bit, type_len;
6618
6619 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6620 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6621 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6622
6623 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6624 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6625 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6626
6627 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6628 }
6629 }
6630
6631 if (opts.addressprint)
6632 bkpttbl_chain
6633 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6634 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6635 "BreakpointTable");
6636 else
6637 bkpttbl_chain
6638 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6639 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6640 "BreakpointTable");
6641
6642 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6643 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6644 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6645 annotate_field (0);
6646 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6647 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6648 annotate_field (1);
6649 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6650 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6651 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6652 annotate_field (2);
6653 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6654 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6655 annotate_field (3);
6656 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6657 if (opts.addressprint)
6658 {
6659 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6660 annotate_field (4);
6661 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6662 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6663 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6664 else
6665 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6666 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6667 }
6668 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6669 annotate_field (5);
6670 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6671 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6672 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6673 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6674
6675 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6676 {
6677 QUIT;
6678 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6679 if (filter && !filter (b))
6680 continue;
6681
6682 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6683 accept. Skip the others. */
6684
6685 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6686 {
6687 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6688 {
6689 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6690 continue;
6691 }
6692 else /* all others */
6693 {
6694 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6695 continue;
6696 }
6697 }
6698 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6699 allflag is set. */
6700 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6701 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6702 }
6703
6704 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6705
6706 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6707 {
6708 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6709 empty list. */
6710 if (!filter)
6711 {
6712 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6713 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6714 else
6715 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
6716 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6717 args);
6718 }
6719 }
6720 else
6721 {
6722 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6723 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6724 }
6725
6726 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6727 there have been breakpoints? */
6728 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6729
6730 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6731 }
6732
6733 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6734 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6735
6736 static void
6737 default_collect_info (void)
6738 {
6739 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6740
6741 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6742 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6743 not wanted. */
6744 if (!*default_collect)
6745 return;
6746
6747 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6748 actions. */
6749 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6750 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6751 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6752 }
6753
6754 static void
6755 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6756 {
6757 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6758
6759 default_collect_info ();
6760 }
6761
6762 static void
6763 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6764 {
6765 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6766 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6767
6768 if (num_printed == 0)
6769 {
6770 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6771 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
6772 else
6773 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6774 }
6775 }
6776
6777 static void
6778 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
6779 {
6780 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6781
6782 default_collect_info ();
6783 }
6784
6785 static int
6786 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6787 struct program_space *pspace,
6788 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6789 {
6790 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6791
6792 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6793 {
6794 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6795 && bl->address == pc
6796 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6797 return 1;
6798 }
6799 return 0;
6800 }
6801
6802 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6803 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6804 address spaces. */
6805
6806 static void
6807 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6808 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6809 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6810 {
6811 int others = 0;
6812 struct breakpoint *b;
6813
6814 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6815 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6816 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6817 if (others > 0)
6818 {
6819 if (others == 1)
6820 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6821 else /* if (others == ???) */
6822 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6823 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6824 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6825 {
6826 others--;
6827 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6828 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6829 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6830 else if (b->thread != -1)
6831 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6832 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6833 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6834 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6835 ? " (disabled)"
6836 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
6837 ? " (permanent)"
6838 : ""),
6839 (others > 1) ? ","
6840 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6841 }
6842 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6843 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6844 printf_filtered (".\n");
6845 }
6846 }
6847 \f
6848
6849 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6850 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
6851 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
6852 (or use it for any other purpose either).
6853
6854 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6855 always have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark
6856 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6857 breakpoint at address zero:
6858
6859 bp_watchpoint
6860 bp_catchpoint
6861
6862 */
6863
6864 static int
6865 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6866 {
6867 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6868
6869 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6870 }
6871
6872 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6873 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6874
6875 static int
6876 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6877 struct bp_location *loc2)
6878 {
6879 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6880 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6881
6882 /* Both of them must exist. */
6883 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6884 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6885
6886 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6887 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6888 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6889 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6890 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6891 other watchpoint. */
6892 if ((w1->cond_exp
6893 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6894 loc1->length,
6895 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6896 w1->cond_exp))
6897 || (w2->cond_exp
6898 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6899 loc2->length,
6900 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6901 w2->cond_exp)))
6902 return 0;
6903
6904 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6905 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6906 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6907 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6908 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6909 become hw_access locations later. */
6910 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6911 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6912 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6913 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6914 }
6915
6916 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6917
6918 int
6919 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6920 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6921 {
6922 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6923 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6924 && addr1 == addr2);
6925 }
6926
6927 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6928 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6929 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6930 space doesn't really matter. */
6931
6932 static int
6933 breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6934 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
6935 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6936 {
6937 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6938 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6939 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6940 }
6941
6942 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6943 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6944 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6945 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6946
6947 static int
6948 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6949 struct address_space *aspace,
6950 CORE_ADDR addr)
6951 {
6952 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6953 aspace, addr)
6954 || (bl->length
6955 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6956 bl->address, bl->length,
6957 aspace, addr)));
6958 }
6959
6960 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6961 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6962 true, otherwise returns false. */
6963
6964 static int
6965 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6966 struct bp_location *loc2)
6967 {
6968 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6969 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6970 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6971 different locations. */
6972 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6973 else
6974 return 0;
6975 }
6976
6977 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6978 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6979 represent the same location. */
6980
6981 static int
6982 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6983 struct bp_location *loc2)
6984 {
6985 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6986
6987 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6988 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6989 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6990
6991 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6992 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6993
6994 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6995 return 0;
6996 else if (hw_point1)
6997 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6998 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6999 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7000 else
7001 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
7002 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
7003 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
7004 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7005 }
7006
7007 static void
7008 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
7009 int bnum, int have_bnum)
7010 {
7011 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
7012 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
7013 char astr1[64];
7014 char astr2[64];
7015
7016 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
7017 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
7018 if (have_bnum)
7019 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7020 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7021 else
7022 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7023 }
7024
7025 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7026 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7027 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7028 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7029
7030 static CORE_ADDR
7031 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7032 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7033 {
7034 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7035 {
7036 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7037 return bpaddr;
7038 }
7039 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7040 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7041 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7042 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7043 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7044 {
7045 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7046 have their addresses modified. */
7047 return bpaddr;
7048 }
7049 else
7050 {
7051 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7052
7053 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7054 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7055 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7056
7057 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7058 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7059 is required. */
7060 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7061 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7062
7063 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7064 }
7065 }
7066
7067 void
7068 init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
7069 struct breakpoint *owner)
7070 {
7071 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
7072
7073 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7074
7075 loc->ops = ops;
7076 loc->owner = owner;
7077 loc->cond = NULL;
7078 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7079 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7080 loc->enabled = 1;
7081
7082 switch (owner->type)
7083 {
7084 case bp_breakpoint:
7085 case bp_until:
7086 case bp_finish:
7087 case bp_longjmp:
7088 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7089 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7090 case bp_exception:
7091 case bp_exception_resume:
7092 case bp_step_resume:
7093 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7094 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7095 case bp_call_dummy:
7096 case bp_std_terminate:
7097 case bp_shlib_event:
7098 case bp_thread_event:
7099 case bp_overlay_event:
7100 case bp_jit_event:
7101 case bp_longjmp_master:
7102 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7103 case bp_exception_master:
7104 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7105 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7106 case bp_dprintf:
7107 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7108 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7109 break;
7110 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7111 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7112 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7113 break;
7114 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7115 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7116 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7117 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7118 break;
7119 case bp_watchpoint:
7120 case bp_catchpoint:
7121 case bp_tracepoint:
7122 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7123 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7124 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7125 break;
7126 default:
7127 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7128 }
7129
7130 loc->refc = 1;
7131 }
7132
7133 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7134
7135 static struct bp_location *
7136 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7137 {
7138 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7139 }
7140
7141 static void
7142 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7143 {
7144 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7145 xfree (loc);
7146 }
7147
7148 /* Increment reference count. */
7149
7150 static void
7151 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7152 {
7153 ++bl->refc;
7154 }
7155
7156 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7157 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7158
7159 static void
7160 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7161 {
7162 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7163
7164 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7165 free_bp_location (*blp);
7166 *blp = NULL;
7167 }
7168
7169 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7170
7171 static void
7172 add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
7173 {
7174 struct breakpoint *b1;
7175
7176 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7177 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7178
7179 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7180 if (b1 == 0)
7181 breakpoint_chain = b;
7182 else
7183 {
7184 while (b1->next)
7185 b1 = b1->next;
7186 b1->next = b;
7187 }
7188 }
7189
7190 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7191
7192 static void
7193 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7194 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7195 enum bptype bptype,
7196 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7197 {
7198 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
7199
7200 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7201
7202 b->ops = ops;
7203 b->type = bptype;
7204 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7205 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7206 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7207 b->thread = -1;
7208 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7209 b->next = 0;
7210 b->silent = 0;
7211 b->ignore_count = 0;
7212 b->commands = NULL;
7213 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
7214 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
7215 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7216 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7217 }
7218
7219 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7220 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7221
7222 static struct breakpoint *
7223 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7224 enum bptype bptype,
7225 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7226 {
7227 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7228
7229 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7230 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7231 return b;
7232 }
7233
7234 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7235 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7236 enough. */
7237
7238 static void
7239 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7240 {
7241 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7242
7243 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7244 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7245 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7246 {
7247 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7248 const char *function_name;
7249 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7250
7251 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7252 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7253
7254 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7255 {
7256 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7257
7258 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7259 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7260 &loc->requested_address))
7261 {
7262 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7263 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7264 loc->requested_address,
7265 b->type);
7266 }
7267 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7268 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7269 {
7270 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7271 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7272 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7273 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7274 breakpoint. */
7275 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7276 }
7277 }
7278
7279 if (function_name)
7280 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7281 }
7282 }
7283
7284 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7285 struct gdbarch *
7286 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7287 {
7288 if (sal.section)
7289 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7290 if (sal.symtab)
7291 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
7292
7293 return NULL;
7294 }
7295
7296 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7297 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7298 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7299
7300 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7301 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7302 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7303
7304 static void
7305 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7306 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7307 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7308 {
7309 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7310
7311 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7312
7313 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7314 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7315
7316 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7317 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7318 program space. */
7319 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7320 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7321 }
7322
7323 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7324 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7325 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7326 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7327 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7328 is also returned as the value of this function.
7329
7330 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7331 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7332 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7333 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7334 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7335 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7336 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7337
7338 struct breakpoint *
7339 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7340 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7341 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7342 {
7343 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7344
7345 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7346 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7347 return b;
7348 }
7349
7350
7351 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
7352 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
7353 void
7354 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
7355 {
7356 struct bp_location *bl;
7357
7358 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
7359
7360 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
7361 code. Mark all locations as inserted. For now,
7362 make_breakpoint_permanent is called in just one place, so it's
7363 hard to say if it's reasonable to have permanent breakpoint with
7364 multiple locations or not, but it's easy to implement. */
7365 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
7366 bl->inserted = 1;
7367 }
7368
7369 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7370 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7371 initiated the operation. */
7372
7373 void
7374 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7375 {
7376 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7377 int thread = tp->num;
7378
7379 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7380 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7381 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7382 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7383 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7384 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7385 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7386 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7387 {
7388 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7389 struct breakpoint *clone;
7390
7391 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7392 after their removal. */
7393 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7394 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7395 clone->thread = thread;
7396 }
7397
7398 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7399 }
7400
7401 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7402 void
7403 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7404 {
7405 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7406
7407 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7408 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7409 {
7410 if (b->thread == thread)
7411 delete_breakpoint (b);
7412 }
7413 }
7414
7415 void
7416 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7417 {
7418 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7419
7420 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7421 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7422 {
7423 if (b->thread == thread)
7424 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7425 }
7426 }
7427
7428 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7429 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7430 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7431 breakpoints. */
7432
7433 struct breakpoint *
7434 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7435 {
7436 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7437
7438 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7439 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7440 {
7441 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7442
7443 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7444 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7445 1);
7446 new_b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7447
7448 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7449
7450 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7451 if (retval == NULL)
7452 retval = new_b;
7453 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7454 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7455 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7456 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7457 }
7458
7459 return retval;
7460 }
7461
7462 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7463 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7464 stack.
7465
7466 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7467 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7468 frames. */
7469
7470 void
7471 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7472 {
7473 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7474
7475 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7476 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->num)
7477 {
7478 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7479
7480 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7481 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7482 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7483 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7484 continue;
7485
7486 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7487
7488 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7489 {
7490 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7491 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7492 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7493 }
7494 delete_breakpoint (b);
7495 }
7496 }
7497
7498 void
7499 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7500 {
7501 struct breakpoint *b;
7502
7503 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7504 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7505 {
7506 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7507 update_global_location_list (1);
7508 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7509 }
7510 }
7511
7512 void
7513 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7514 {
7515 struct breakpoint *b;
7516
7517 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7518 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7519 {
7520 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7521 update_global_location_list (0);
7522 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7523 }
7524 }
7525
7526 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7527 master breakpoint. */
7528 void
7529 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7530 {
7531 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7532
7533 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7534 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7535 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7536 {
7537 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7538 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7539 }
7540 }
7541
7542 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7543 void
7544 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7545 {
7546 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7547
7548 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7549 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7550 delete_breakpoint (b);
7551 }
7552
7553 struct breakpoint *
7554 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7555 {
7556 struct breakpoint *b;
7557
7558 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7559 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7560
7561 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7562 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7563 b->addr_string
7564 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
7565
7566 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
7567
7568 return b;
7569 }
7570
7571 void
7572 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
7573 {
7574 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7575
7576 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7577 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
7578 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7579 delete_breakpoint (b);
7580 }
7581
7582 struct lang_and_radix
7583 {
7584 enum language lang;
7585 int radix;
7586 };
7587
7588 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7589
7590 struct breakpoint *
7591 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7592 {
7593 struct breakpoint *b;
7594
7595 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7596 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7597 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
7598 return b;
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7602
7603 void
7604 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7605 {
7606 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7607
7608 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7609 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7610 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7611 delete_breakpoint (b);
7612 }
7613
7614 void
7615 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7616 {
7617 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7618
7619 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7620 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7621 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7622 delete_breakpoint (b);
7623 }
7624
7625 struct breakpoint *
7626 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7627 {
7628 struct breakpoint *b;
7629
7630 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7631 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7632 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
7633 return b;
7634 }
7635
7636 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7637 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7638
7639 void
7640 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7641 {
7642 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7643
7644 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7645 {
7646 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7647 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7648
7649 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7650 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7651 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7652 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7653 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7654 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7655 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7656 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7657 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7658 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7659 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7660 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7661 )
7662 {
7663 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7664 }
7665 }
7666 }
7667
7668 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7669 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7670 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7671
7672 static void
7673 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7674 {
7675 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7676 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7677
7678 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7679 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7680 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7681 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7682 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7683 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7684 return;
7685
7686 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7687 {
7688 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7689 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7690
7691 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7692 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7693 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7694 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7695 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7696 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7697 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7698 || is_tracepoint (b))
7699 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7700 {
7701 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7702 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7703 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7704 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7705 loc->inserted = 0;
7706
7707 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7708 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7709
7710 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7711 {
7712 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7713 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7714 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7715 solib->so_name);
7716 }
7717 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7718 }
7719 }
7720 }
7721
7722 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7723 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7724 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7725
7726 static void
7727 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7728 {
7729 struct breakpoint *b;
7730
7731 if (objfile == NULL)
7732 return;
7733
7734 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7735 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7736 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7737 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7738 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7739 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7740 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7741 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7742 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7743 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7744 main objfile). */
7745 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7746 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7747 return;
7748
7749 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7750 {
7751 struct bp_location *loc;
7752 int bp_modified = 0;
7753
7754 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7755 continue;
7756
7757 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7758 {
7759 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7760
7761 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7762 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7763 continue;
7764
7765 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7766 continue;
7767
7768 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7769 continue;
7770
7771 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7772 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7773 continue;
7774
7775 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7776 {
7777 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7778 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7779 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7780 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7781 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7782 unmapped. */
7783
7784 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7785
7786 bp_modified = 1;
7787 }
7788 }
7789
7790 if (bp_modified)
7791 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7792 }
7793 }
7794
7795 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7796
7797 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7798 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
7799 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
7800 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7801 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7802
7803 struct fork_catchpoint
7804 {
7805 /* The base class. */
7806 struct breakpoint base;
7807
7808 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7809 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7810 catchpoint has triggered. */
7811 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7812 };
7813
7814 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7815 catchpoints. */
7816
7817 static int
7818 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7819 {
7820 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7821 }
7822
7823 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7824 catchpoints. */
7825
7826 static int
7827 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7828 {
7829 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7830 }
7831
7832 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7833 catchpoints. */
7834
7835 static int
7836 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7837 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7838 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7839 {
7840 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7841
7842 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7843 return 0;
7844
7845 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7846 return 1;
7847 }
7848
7849 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7850 catchpoints. */
7851
7852 static enum print_stop_action
7853 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7854 {
7855 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7856 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7857 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7858
7859 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7860 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7861 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7862 else
7863 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7864 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7865 {
7866 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7867 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7868 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7869 }
7870 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7871 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
7872 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7873 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
7874 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7875 }
7876
7877 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7878 catchpoints. */
7879
7880 static void
7881 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7882 {
7883 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7884 struct value_print_options opts;
7885 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7886
7887 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7888
7889 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7890 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7891 readable). */
7892 if (opts.addressprint)
7893 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
7894 annotate_field (5);
7895 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
7896 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7897 {
7898 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
7899 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
7900 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7901 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
7902 }
7903
7904 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7905 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "fork");
7906 }
7907
7908 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7909 catchpoints. */
7910
7911 static void
7912 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7913 {
7914 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7915 }
7916
7917 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7918 catchpoints. */
7919
7920 static void
7921 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7922 {
7923 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7924 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7925 }
7926
7927 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7928
7929 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7930
7931 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7932 catchpoints. */
7933
7934 static int
7935 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7936 {
7937 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7938 }
7939
7940 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7941 catchpoints. */
7942
7943 static int
7944 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7945 {
7946 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7947 }
7948
7949 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7950 catchpoints. */
7951
7952 static int
7953 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7954 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7955 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7956 {
7957 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7958
7959 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7960 return 0;
7961
7962 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7963 return 1;
7964 }
7965
7966 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7967 catchpoints. */
7968
7969 static enum print_stop_action
7970 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7971 {
7972 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7973 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7974 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7975
7976 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7977 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7978 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7979 else
7980 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7981 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7982 {
7983 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7984 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7985 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7986 }
7987 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7988 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
7989 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7990 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
7991 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7992 }
7993
7994 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7995 catchpoints. */
7996
7997 static void
7998 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7999 {
8000 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8001 struct value_print_options opts;
8002 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8003
8004 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8005 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8006 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8007 readable). */
8008 if (opts.addressprint)
8009 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8010 annotate_field (5);
8011 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
8012 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8013 {
8014 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8015 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8016 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8017 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8018 }
8019
8020 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8021 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "vfork");
8022 }
8023
8024 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8025 catchpoints. */
8026
8027 static void
8028 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8029 {
8030 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8031 }
8032
8033 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8034 catchpoints. */
8035
8036 static void
8037 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8038 {
8039 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8040 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8041 }
8042
8043 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8044
8045 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8046
8047 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8048 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8049 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8050 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8051 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8052
8053 struct solib_catchpoint
8054 {
8055 /* The base class. */
8056 struct breakpoint base;
8057
8058 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8059 unsigned char is_load;
8060
8061 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8062 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8063 char *regex;
8064 regex_t compiled;
8065 };
8066
8067 static void
8068 dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8069 {
8070 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8071
8072 if (self->regex)
8073 regfree (&self->compiled);
8074 xfree (self->regex);
8075
8076 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8077 }
8078
8079 static int
8080 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8081 {
8082 return 0;
8083 }
8084
8085 static int
8086 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8087 {
8088 return 0;
8089 }
8090
8091 static int
8092 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8093 struct address_space *aspace,
8094 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8095 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8096 {
8097 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8098 struct breakpoint *other;
8099
8100 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8101 return 1;
8102
8103 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8104 {
8105 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8106
8107 if (other == bl->owner)
8108 continue;
8109
8110 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8111 continue;
8112
8113 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
8114 continue;
8115
8116 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8117 {
8118 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8119 return 1;
8120 }
8121 }
8122
8123 return 0;
8124 }
8125
8126 static void
8127 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8128 {
8129 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8130 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8131 int ix;
8132
8133 if (self->is_load)
8134 {
8135 struct so_list *iter;
8136
8137 for (ix = 0;
8138 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8139 ix, iter);
8140 ++ix)
8141 {
8142 if (!self->regex
8143 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8144 return;
8145 }
8146 }
8147 else
8148 {
8149 char *iter;
8150
8151 for (ix = 0;
8152 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8153 ix, iter);
8154 ++ix)
8155 {
8156 if (!self->regex
8157 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8158 return;
8159 }
8160 }
8161
8162 bs->stop = 0;
8163 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8164 }
8165
8166 static enum print_stop_action
8167 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8168 {
8169 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8170 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8171
8172 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8173 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8174 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8175 else
8176 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8177 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8178 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
8179 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8180 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8181 print_solib_event (1);
8182 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8183 }
8184
8185 static void
8186 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8187 {
8188 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8189 struct value_print_options opts;
8190 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8191 char *msg;
8192
8193 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8194 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8195 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8196 readable). */
8197 if (opts.addressprint)
8198 {
8199 annotate_field (4);
8200 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8201 }
8202
8203 annotate_field (5);
8204 if (self->is_load)
8205 {
8206 if (self->regex)
8207 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8208 else
8209 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8210 }
8211 else
8212 {
8213 if (self->regex)
8214 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8215 else
8216 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8217 }
8218 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
8219 xfree (msg);
8220
8221 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8222 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type",
8223 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8224 }
8225
8226 static void
8227 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8228 {
8229 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8230
8231 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8232 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8233 }
8234
8235 static void
8236 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8237 {
8238 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8239
8240 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8241 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8242 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8243 if (self->regex)
8244 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8245 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8246 }
8247
8248 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8249
8250 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8251 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8252 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8253 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8254 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8255 created in an enabled state. */
8256
8257 void
8258 add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8259 {
8260 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
8261 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8262 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8263
8264 if (!arg)
8265 arg = "";
8266 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8267
8268 c = XCNEW (struct solib_catchpoint);
8269 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
8270
8271 if (*arg != '\0')
8272 {
8273 int errcode;
8274
8275 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
8276 if (errcode != 0)
8277 {
8278 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
8279
8280 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
8281 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
8282 }
8283 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8284 }
8285
8286 c->is_load = is_load;
8287 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8288 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8289
8290 c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8291
8292 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8293 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8294 }
8295
8296 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8297 "catch unload". */
8298
8299 static void
8300 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8301 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8302 {
8303 int tempflag;
8304 const int enabled = 1;
8305
8306 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8307
8308 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8309 }
8310
8311 static void
8312 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8313 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8314 {
8315 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8316 }
8317
8318 static void
8319 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8320 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8321 {
8322 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8323 }
8324
8325 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a syscall catchpoint.
8326 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8327 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8328 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8329 CATCH_SYSCALL_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8330
8331 struct syscall_catchpoint
8332 {
8333 /* The base class. */
8334 struct breakpoint base;
8335
8336 /* Syscall numbers used for the 'catch syscall' feature. If no
8337 syscall has been specified for filtering, its value is NULL.
8338 Otherwise, it holds a list of all syscalls to be caught. The
8339 list elements are allocated with xmalloc. */
8340 VEC(int) *syscalls_to_be_caught;
8341 };
8342
8343 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8344 catchpoints. */
8345
8346 static void
8347 dtor_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
8348 {
8349 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8350
8351 VEC_free (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8352
8353 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8354 }
8355
8356 static const struct inferior_data *catch_syscall_inferior_data = NULL;
8357
8358 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data
8359 {
8360 /* We keep a count of the number of times the user has requested a
8361 particular syscall to be tracked, and pass this information to the
8362 target. This lets capable targets implement filtering directly. */
8363
8364 /* Number of times that "any" syscall is requested. */
8365 int any_syscall_count;
8366
8367 /* Count of each system call. */
8368 VEC(int) *syscalls_counts;
8369
8370 /* This counts all syscall catch requests, so we can readily determine
8371 if any catching is necessary. */
8372 int total_syscalls_count;
8373 };
8374
8375 static struct catch_syscall_inferior_data*
8376 get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
8377 {
8378 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data;
8379
8380 inf_data = inferior_data (inf, catch_syscall_inferior_data);
8381 if (inf_data == NULL)
8382 {
8383 inf_data = XCNEW (struct catch_syscall_inferior_data);
8384 set_inferior_data (inf, catch_syscall_inferior_data, inf_data);
8385 }
8386
8387 return inf_data;
8388 }
8389
8390 static void
8391 catch_syscall_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
8392 {
8393 xfree (arg);
8394 }
8395
8396
8397 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8398 catchpoints. */
8399
8400 static int
8401 insert_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
8402 {
8403 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8404 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
8405 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
8406 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
8407
8408 ++inf_data->total_syscalls_count;
8409 if (!c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8410 ++inf_data->any_syscall_count;
8411 else
8412 {
8413 int i, iter;
8414
8415 for (i = 0;
8416 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8417 i++)
8418 {
8419 int elem;
8420
8421 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts))
8422 {
8423 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts);
8424 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset
8425 = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
8426 uintptr_t vec_addr;
8427 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
8428 vec_addr = ((uintptr_t) VEC_address (int,
8429 inf_data->syscalls_counts)
8430 + vec_addr_offset);
8431 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
8432 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
8433 }
8434 elem = VEC_index (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter);
8435 VEC_replace (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
8436 }
8437 }
8438
8439 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid),
8440 inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0,
8441 inf_data->any_syscall_count,
8442 VEC_length (int,
8443 inf_data->syscalls_counts),
8444 VEC_address (int,
8445 inf_data->syscalls_counts));
8446 }
8447
8448 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8449 catchpoints. */
8450
8451 static int
8452 remove_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
8453 {
8454 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8455 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
8456 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
8457 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
8458
8459 --inf_data->total_syscalls_count;
8460 if (!c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8461 --inf_data->any_syscall_count;
8462 else
8463 {
8464 int i, iter;
8465
8466 for (i = 0;
8467 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8468 i++)
8469 {
8470 int elem;
8471 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts))
8472 /* Shouldn't happen. */
8473 continue;
8474 elem = VEC_index (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter);
8475 VEC_replace (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
8476 }
8477 }
8478
8479 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid),
8480 inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0,
8481 inf_data->any_syscall_count,
8482 VEC_length (int,
8483 inf_data->syscalls_counts),
8484 VEC_address (int,
8485 inf_data->syscalls_counts));
8486 }
8487
8488 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8489 catchpoints. */
8490
8491 static int
8492 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (const struct bp_location *bl,
8493 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8494 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8495 {
8496 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this
8497 breakpoint. If we are, then we must guarantee that the called
8498 syscall is the same syscall we are catching. */
8499 int syscall_number = 0;
8500 const struct syscall_catchpoint *c
8501 = (const struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8502
8503 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8504 && ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
8505 return 0;
8506
8507 syscall_number = ws->value.syscall_number;
8508
8509 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
8510 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8511 {
8512 int i, iter;
8513
8514 for (i = 0;
8515 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8516 i++)
8517 if (syscall_number == iter)
8518 return 1;
8519
8520 return 0;
8521 }
8522
8523 return 1;
8524 }
8525
8526 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8527 catchpoints. */
8528
8529 static enum print_stop_action
8530 print_it_catch_syscall (bpstat bs)
8531 {
8532 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8533 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8534 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
8535 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8536 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
8537 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
8538 ptid_t ptid;
8539 struct target_waitstatus last;
8540 struct syscall s;
8541
8542 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
8543
8544 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
8545
8546 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8547
8548 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8549 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8550 else
8551 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8552 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8553 {
8554 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8555 async_reason_lookup (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8556 ? EXEC_ASYNC_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8557 : EXEC_ASYNC_SYSCALL_RETURN));
8558 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8559 }
8560 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8561
8562 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
8563 ui_out_text (uiout, " (call to syscall ");
8564 else
8565 ui_out_text (uiout, " (returned from syscall ");
8566
8567 if (s.name == NULL || ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8568 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "syscall-number", last.value.syscall_number);
8569 if (s.name != NULL)
8570 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "syscall-name", s.name);
8571
8572 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8573
8574 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8575 }
8576
8577 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8578 catchpoints. */
8579
8580 static void
8581 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
8582 struct bp_location **last_loc)
8583 {
8584 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8585 struct value_print_options opts;
8586 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8587
8588 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8589 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8590 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8591 readable). */
8592 if (opts.addressprint)
8593 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8594 annotate_field (5);
8595
8596 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught
8597 && VEC_length (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
8598 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
8599 else
8600 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
8601
8602 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8603 {
8604 int i, iter;
8605 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
8606
8607 for (i = 0;
8608 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8609 i++)
8610 {
8611 char *x = text;
8612 struct syscall s;
8613 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8614
8615 if (s.name != NULL)
8616 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
8617 else
8618 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
8619
8620 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
8621 because xstrprintf dynamically allocates new space for it
8622 on every call. */
8623 xfree (x);
8624 }
8625 /* Remove the last comma. */
8626 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
8627 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
8628 }
8629 else
8630 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
8631 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8632
8633 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8634 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "syscall");
8635 }
8636
8637 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8638 catchpoints. */
8639
8640 static void
8641 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
8642 {
8643 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8644
8645 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8646 {
8647 int i, iter;
8648
8649 if (VEC_length (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
8650 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
8651 else
8652 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
8653
8654 for (i = 0;
8655 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8656 i++)
8657 {
8658 struct syscall s;
8659 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8660
8661 if (s.name)
8662 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
8663 else
8664 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
8665 }
8666 printf_filtered (")");
8667 }
8668 else
8669 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
8670 b->number);
8671 }
8672
8673 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8674 catchpoints. */
8675
8676 static void
8677 print_recreate_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8678 {
8679 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8680
8681 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch syscall");
8682
8683 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8684 {
8685 int i, iter;
8686
8687 for (i = 0;
8688 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8689 i++)
8690 {
8691 struct syscall s;
8692
8693 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8694 if (s.name)
8695 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", s.name);
8696 else
8697 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %d", s.number);
8698 }
8699 }
8700 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8701 }
8702
8703 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
8704
8705 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops;
8706
8707 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
8708
8709 static int
8710 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
8711 {
8712 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8713 }
8714
8715 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8716 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8717 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8718 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8719
8720 void
8721 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8722 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8723 char *cond_string,
8724 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8725 {
8726 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8727
8728 init_sal (&sal);
8729 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8730
8731 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8732
8733 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8734 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8735 }
8736
8737 void
8738 install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8739 {
8740 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8741 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8742 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8743 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8744 if (!internal)
8745 mention (b);
8746 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8747
8748 if (update_gll)
8749 update_global_location_list (1);
8750 }
8751
8752 static void
8753 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8754 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8755 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8756 {
8757 struct fork_catchpoint *c = XNEW (struct fork_catchpoint);
8758
8759 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8760
8761 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8762
8763 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8764 }
8765
8766 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8767
8768 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8769 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8770 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8771 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8772 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8773
8774 struct exec_catchpoint
8775 {
8776 /* The base class. */
8777 struct breakpoint base;
8778
8779 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8780 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8781 triggered. */
8782 char *exec_pathname;
8783 };
8784
8785 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8786 catchpoints. */
8787
8788 static void
8789 dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8790 {
8791 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8792
8793 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8794
8795 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8796 }
8797
8798 static int
8799 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8800 {
8801 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8802 }
8803
8804 static int
8805 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8806 {
8807 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8808 }
8809
8810 static int
8811 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8812 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8813 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8814 {
8815 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8816
8817 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8818 return 0;
8819
8820 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8821 return 1;
8822 }
8823
8824 static enum print_stop_action
8825 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8826 {
8827 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8828 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8829 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8830
8831 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8832 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8833 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8834 else
8835 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8836 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8837 {
8838 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8839 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8840 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8841 }
8842 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8843 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8844 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8845 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8846
8847 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8848 }
8849
8850 static void
8851 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8852 {
8853 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8854 struct value_print_options opts;
8855 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8856
8857 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8858
8859 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8860 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8861 is relatively readable). */
8862 if (opts.addressprint)
8863 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8864 annotate_field (5);
8865 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8866 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8867 {
8868 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8869 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8870 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8871 }
8872
8873 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8874 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "exec");
8875 }
8876
8877 static void
8878 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8879 {
8880 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8881 }
8882
8883 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8884 catchpoints. */
8885
8886 static void
8887 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8888 {
8889 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8890 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8891 }
8892
8893 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8894
8895 static void
8896 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
8897 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8898 {
8899 struct syscall_catchpoint *c;
8900 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8901
8902 c = XNEW (struct syscall_catchpoint);
8903 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
8904 c->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
8905
8906 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8907 }
8908
8909 static int
8910 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8911 {
8912 int i = 0;
8913 struct breakpoint *b;
8914 struct bp_location *bl;
8915
8916 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8917 {
8918 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8919 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8920 {
8921 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8922 one register. */
8923 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8924 }
8925 }
8926
8927 return i;
8928 }
8929
8930 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8931 watchpoint. */
8932
8933 static int
8934 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8935 {
8936 int i = 0;
8937 struct bp_location *bl;
8938
8939 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8940 return 0;
8941
8942 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8943 {
8944 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8945 one register. */
8946 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8947 }
8948
8949 return i;
8950 }
8951
8952 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8953 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8954 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8955 types _not_ TYPE. */
8956
8957 static int
8958 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8959 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8960 {
8961 int i = 0;
8962 struct breakpoint *b;
8963
8964 *other_type_used = 0;
8965 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8966 {
8967 if (b == except)
8968 continue;
8969 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8970 continue;
8971
8972 if (b->type == type)
8973 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8974 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8975 *other_type_used = 1;
8976 }
8977
8978 return i;
8979 }
8980
8981 void
8982 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8983 {
8984 struct breakpoint *b;
8985
8986 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8987 {
8988 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8989 {
8990 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8991 update_global_location_list (0);
8992 }
8993 }
8994 }
8995
8996 void
8997 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8998 {
8999 struct breakpoint *b;
9000
9001 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9002 {
9003 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
9004 {
9005 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9006 update_global_location_list (1);
9007 }
9008 }
9009 }
9010
9011 void
9012 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
9013 {
9014 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
9015 update_global_location_list (0);
9016 }
9017
9018 void
9019 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
9020 {
9021 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
9022 breakpoint_re_set ();
9023 }
9024
9025
9026 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
9027 at address specified by SAL.
9028 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
9029
9030 struct breakpoint *
9031 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
9032 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
9033 {
9034 struct breakpoint *b;
9035
9036 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
9037 tail-called one. */
9038 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
9039
9040 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
9041 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9042 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9043 b->frame_id = frame_id;
9044
9045 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
9046 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
9047 control. */
9048 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9049 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9050
9051 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
9052
9053 return b;
9054 }
9055
9056 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
9057 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
9058 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
9059
9060 static struct breakpoint *
9061 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
9062 enum bptype type,
9063 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9064 int loc_enabled)
9065 {
9066 struct breakpoint *copy;
9067
9068 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
9069 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
9070 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
9071
9072 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
9073 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
9074 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
9075 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
9076 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
9077 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
9078 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
9079 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
9080 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
9081 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
9082 copy->thread = orig->thread;
9083 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
9084
9085 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9086 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9087 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
9088
9089 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
9090 return copy;
9091 }
9092
9093 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
9094 ORIG is NULL. */
9095
9096 struct breakpoint *
9097 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
9098 {
9099 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
9100 if (orig == NULL)
9101 return NULL;
9102
9103 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
9104 }
9105
9106 struct breakpoint *
9107 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
9108 enum bptype type)
9109 {
9110 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9111
9112 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9113 sal.pc = pc;
9114 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
9115 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9116
9117 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
9118 }
9119 \f
9120
9121 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
9122
9123 static void
9124 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
9125 {
9126 b->ops->print_mention (b);
9127 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
9128 return;
9129 printf_filtered ("\n");
9130 }
9131 \f
9132
9133 static struct bp_location *
9134 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9135 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9136 {
9137 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
9138 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
9139 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9140
9141 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
9142 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
9143
9144 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
9145 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
9146 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
9147 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
9148 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
9149 location that's only been partially initialized. */
9150 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
9151 sal->pc, b->type);
9152
9153 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
9154 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
9155 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
9156 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
9157 ;
9158 loc->next = *tmp;
9159 *tmp = loc;
9160
9161 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
9162 loc->address = adjusted_address;
9163 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
9164 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
9165 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
9166 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
9167 loc->section = sal->section;
9168 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
9169 loc->line_number = sal->line;
9170 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
9171
9172 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
9173 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
9174 return loc;
9175 }
9176 \f
9177
9178 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
9179 return 0 otherwise. */
9180
9181 static int
9182 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
9183 {
9184 int len;
9185 CORE_ADDR addr;
9186 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
9187 gdb_byte *target_mem;
9188 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9189 int retval = 0;
9190
9191 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
9192
9193 addr = loc->address;
9194 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
9195
9196 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
9197 if (bpoint == NULL)
9198 return 0;
9199
9200 target_mem = alloca (len);
9201
9202 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
9203 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
9204 breakpoints they are permanent. */
9205 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9206
9207 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
9208 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
9209
9210 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
9211 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
9212 retval = 1;
9213
9214 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9215
9216 return retval;
9217 }
9218
9219 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
9220 settings of the dprintf style options. */
9221
9222 static void
9223 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
9224 {
9225 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
9226 char *printf_line = NULL;
9227
9228 if (!dprintf_args)
9229 return;
9230
9231 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9232
9233 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
9234 insist on it. */
9235 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
9236 ++dprintf_args;
9237 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9238
9239 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
9240 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
9241
9242 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
9243 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9244 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
9245 {
9246 if (!dprintf_function)
9247 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
9248
9249 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
9250 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
9251 dprintf_function,
9252 dprintf_channel,
9253 dprintf_args);
9254 else
9255 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
9256 dprintf_function,
9257 dprintf_args);
9258 }
9259 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
9260 {
9261 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
9262 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
9263 else
9264 {
9265 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
9266 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9267 }
9268 }
9269 else
9270 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9271 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
9272
9273 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
9274 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
9275 {
9276 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
9277 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct command_line));
9278
9279 printf_cmd_line = xmalloc (sizeof (struct command_line));
9280 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
9281 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
9282 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
9283 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
9284 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
9285
9286 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
9287 }
9288 }
9289
9290 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
9291 current style settings. */
9292
9293 static void
9294 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
9295 struct cmd_list_element *c)
9296 {
9297 struct breakpoint *b;
9298
9299 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9300 {
9301 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
9302 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9303 }
9304 }
9305
9306 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
9307 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
9308 as condition expression. */
9309
9310 static void
9311 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9312 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
9313 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9314 char *extra_string,
9315 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9316 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9317 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9318 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9319 int display_canonical)
9320 {
9321 int i;
9322
9323 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9324 {
9325 int target_resources_ok;
9326
9327 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9328 target_resources_ok =
9329 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9330 i + 1, 0);
9331 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9332 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9333 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9334 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9335 }
9336
9337 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
9338
9339 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9340 {
9341 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
9342 struct bp_location *loc;
9343
9344 if (from_tty)
9345 {
9346 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9347 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9348 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9349
9350 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9351 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
9352 }
9353
9354 if (i == 0)
9355 {
9356 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
9357 b->thread = thread;
9358 b->task = task;
9359
9360 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9361 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9362 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9363 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9364 b->disposition = disposition;
9365
9366 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9367 b->loc->inserted = 1;
9368
9369 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
9370 {
9371 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
9372 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9373
9374 if (strace_marker_p (b))
9375 {
9376 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
9377 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
9378 char *p = &addr_string[3];
9379 char *endp;
9380 char *marker_str;
9381
9382 p = skip_spaces (p);
9383
9384 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9385
9386 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9387 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
9388
9389 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9390 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9391 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9392 }
9393 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
9394 {
9395 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9396 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9397
9398 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9399 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9400 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9401 }
9402 else
9403 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
9404 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
9405 }
9406
9407 loc = b->loc;
9408 }
9409 else
9410 {
9411 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
9412 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9413 loc->inserted = 1;
9414 }
9415
9416 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
9417 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
9418
9419 if (b->cond_string)
9420 {
9421 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9422
9423 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9424 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9425 if (*arg)
9426 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9427 }
9428
9429 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9430 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9431 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9432 {
9433 if (b->extra_string)
9434 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9435 else
9436 error (_("Format string required"));
9437 }
9438 else if (b->extra_string)
9439 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9440 }
9441
9442 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9443 if (addr_string)
9444 b->addr_string = addr_string;
9445 else
9446 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
9447 me. */
9448 b->addr_string
9449 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
9450 b->filter = filter;
9451 }
9452
9453 static void
9454 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9455 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
9456 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9457 char *extra_string,
9458 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9459 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9460 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9461 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9462 int display_canonical)
9463 {
9464 struct breakpoint *b;
9465 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9466
9467 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
9468 {
9469 struct tracepoint *t;
9470
9471 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9472 b = &t->base;
9473 }
9474 else
9475 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9476
9477 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
9478
9479 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
9480 sals, addr_string,
9481 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
9482 type, disposition,
9483 thread, task, ignore_count,
9484 ops, from_tty,
9485 enabled, internal, flags,
9486 display_canonical);
9487 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
9488
9489 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9490 }
9491
9492 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9493 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9494 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9495 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9496 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9497 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9498 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9499 we take just a single condition string.
9500
9501 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9502 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9503 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9504 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9505 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9506
9507 static void
9508 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9509 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9510 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
9511 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9512 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9513 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9514 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9515 {
9516 int i;
9517 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9518
9519 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9520 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
9521
9522 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
9523 {
9524 /* Note that 'addr_string' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9525 'break', without arguments. */
9526 char *addr_string = (canonical->addr_string
9527 ? xstrdup (canonical->addr_string)
9528 : NULL);
9529 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
9530 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
9531
9532 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
9533 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
9534 addr_string,
9535 filter_string,
9536 cond_string, extra_string,
9537 type, disposition,
9538 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9539 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9540 canonical->special_display);
9541 discard_cleanups (inner);
9542 }
9543 }
9544
9545 /* Parse ADDRESS which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9546 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9547 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
9548 address strings. ADDRESS points to the end of the SAL.
9549
9550 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9551 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9552
9553 static void
9554 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
9555 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9556 {
9557 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
9558 breakpoint. */
9559 if ((*address) == NULL
9560 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
9561 {
9562 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default breakpoint
9563 address. */
9564 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9565 {
9566 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9567 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9568 CORE_ADDR pc;
9569
9570 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9571 lsal.sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
9572 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
9573
9574 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9575 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9576 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9577 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9578 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9579 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
9580 pc = sal.pc;
9581 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9582
9583 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9584 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9585 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9586 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9587 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9588 sal.pc = pc;
9589 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9590
9591 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
9592 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9593 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9594
9595 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
9596 }
9597 else
9598 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9599 }
9600 else
9601 {
9602 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9603
9604 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9605 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9606 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9607 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9608
9609 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9610 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9611 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
9612 && (!cursal.symtab
9613 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
9614 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
9615 decode_line_full (address, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9616 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9617 get_last_displayed_line (),
9618 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9619 else
9620 decode_line_full (address, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9621 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9622 }
9623 }
9624
9625
9626 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9627 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9628
9629 static void
9630 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9631 {
9632 int i;
9633
9634 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9635 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
9636 }
9637
9638 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9639 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9640 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9641 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9642 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9643 it, etc. */
9644
9645 static void
9646 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9647 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9648 {
9649 int i, rslt;
9650 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
9651 char *msg;
9652 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9653
9654 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9655 {
9656 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9657
9658 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9659
9660 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9661 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9662 associated with SAL. */
9663 if (sarch == NULL)
9664 sarch = gdbarch;
9665 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc,
9666 NULL, &msg);
9667 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9668
9669 if (!rslt)
9670 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
9671 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9672
9673 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9674 }
9675 }
9676
9677 /* Issue an invalid thread ID error. */
9678
9679 static void ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN
9680 invalid_thread_id_error (int id)
9681 {
9682 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), id);
9683 }
9684
9685 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9686 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9687 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9688 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9689 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9690 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9691
9692 static void
9693 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9694 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9695 char **rest)
9696 {
9697 *cond_string = NULL;
9698 *thread = -1;
9699 *task = 0;
9700 *rest = NULL;
9701
9702 while (tok && *tok)
9703 {
9704 const char *end_tok;
9705 int toklen;
9706 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9707 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9708
9709 tok = skip_spaces_const (tok);
9710
9711 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9712 {
9713 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9714 return;
9715 }
9716
9717 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
9718
9719 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9720
9721 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9722 {
9723 struct expression *expr;
9724
9725 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9726 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9727 xfree (expr);
9728 cond_end = tok;
9729 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9730 }
9731 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9732 {
9733 char *tmptok;
9734
9735 tok = end_tok + 1;
9736 *thread = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9737 if (tok == tmptok)
9738 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9739 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
9740 invalid_thread_id_error (*thread);
9741 tok = tmptok;
9742 }
9743 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9744 {
9745 char *tmptok;
9746
9747 tok = end_tok + 1;
9748 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9749 if (tok == tmptok)
9750 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9751 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9752 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9753 tok = tmptok;
9754 }
9755 else if (rest)
9756 {
9757 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9758 return;
9759 }
9760 else
9761 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9762 }
9763 }
9764
9765 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9766
9767 static struct symtabs_and_lines
9768 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (char **arg_p)
9769 {
9770 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9771 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9772 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9773 char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9774 char *endp;
9775 char *marker_str;
9776 int i;
9777
9778 p = skip_spaces (p);
9779
9780 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9781
9782 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9783 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9784
9785 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9786 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9787 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9788
9789 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9790 sals.sals = xmalloc (sizeof *sals.sals * sals.nelts);
9791
9792 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9793 {
9794 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9795
9796 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9797
9798 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9799
9800 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9801 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9802
9803 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9804 }
9805
9806 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9807
9808 *arg_p = endp;
9809 return sals;
9810 }
9811
9812 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
9813 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
9814 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_ARG parameter. If
9815 non-zero, the function will parse ARG, extracting location,
9816 condition, thread and extra string. Otherwise, ARG is just the
9817 breakpoint's location, with condition, thread, and extra string
9818 specified by the COND_STRING, THREAD and EXTRA_STRING parameters.
9819 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be allocated
9820 from the internal breakpoint count. Returns true if any breakpoint
9821 was created; false otherwise. */
9822
9823 int
9824 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9825 char *arg, char *cond_string,
9826 int thread, char *extra_string,
9827 int parse_arg,
9828 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9829 int ignore_count,
9830 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9831 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9832 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9833 unsigned flags)
9834 {
9835 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
9836 char *copy_arg = NULL;
9837 char *addr_start = arg;
9838 struct linespec_result canonical;
9839 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9840 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9841 int pending = 0;
9842 int task = 0;
9843 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9844
9845 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9846
9847 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9848
9849 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9850 {
9851 ops->create_sals_from_address (&arg, &canonical, type_wanted,
9852 addr_start, &copy_arg);
9853 }
9854
9855 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
9856 switch (e.reason)
9857 {
9858 case GDB_NO_ERROR:
9859 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9860 return 0;
9861 break;
9862 case RETURN_ERROR:
9863 switch (e.error)
9864 {
9865 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
9866
9867 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9868 error. */
9869
9870 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9871 throw_exception (e);
9872
9873 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9874
9875 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9876 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9877 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9878 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9879 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9880 return 0;
9881
9882 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9883 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9884 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9885 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9886 {
9887 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9888
9889 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
9890 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (copy_arg);
9891 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9892 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9893 init_sal (&lsal.sals.sals[0]);
9894 pending = 1;
9895 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, &lsal);
9896 }
9897 break;
9898 default:
9899 throw_exception (e);
9900 }
9901 break;
9902 default:
9903 throw_exception (e);
9904 }
9905
9906 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
9907 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
9908
9909 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9910 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9911 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9912 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9913 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9914
9915 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9916 are ok for the target. */
9917 if (!pending)
9918 {
9919 int ix;
9920 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9921
9922 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9923 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
9924 }
9925
9926 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9927 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9928 {
9929 int ix;
9930 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9931
9932 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9933 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
9934 }
9935
9936 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9937 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9938 breakpoint. */
9939 if (!pending)
9940 {
9941 if (parse_arg)
9942 {
9943 char *rest;
9944 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9945
9946 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
9947
9948 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9949 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9950 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9951 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9952
9953 find_condition_and_thread (arg, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
9954 &thread, &task, &rest);
9955 if (cond_string)
9956 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9957 if (rest)
9958 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
9959 if (rest)
9960 extra_string = rest;
9961 }
9962 else
9963 {
9964 if (*arg != '\0')
9965 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), arg);
9966
9967 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9968 if (cond_string)
9969 {
9970 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9971 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9972 }
9973 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9974 if (extra_string)
9975 {
9976 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9977 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9978 }
9979 }
9980
9981 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9982 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
9983 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9984 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9985 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9986 }
9987 else
9988 {
9989 struct breakpoint *b;
9990
9991 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
9992
9993 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
9994 {
9995 struct tracepoint *t;
9996
9997 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9998 b = &t->base;
9999 }
10000 else
10001 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
10002
10003 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
10004
10005 b->addr_string = copy_arg;
10006 if (parse_arg)
10007 b->cond_string = NULL;
10008 else
10009 {
10010 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
10011 if (cond_string)
10012 {
10013 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
10014 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
10015 }
10016 b->cond_string = cond_string;
10017 }
10018 b->extra_string = NULL;
10019 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
10020 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
10021 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
10022 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
10023 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
10024 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
10025 b->pspace = current_program_space;
10026
10027 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
10028 }
10029
10030 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
10031 {
10032 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
10033 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
10034 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
10035 }
10036
10037 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
10038 breakpoint. */
10039 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
10040 /* But cleanup everything else. */
10041 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10042
10043 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
10044 update_global_location_list (1);
10045
10046 return 1;
10047 }
10048
10049 /* Set a breakpoint.
10050 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
10051 condition, and thread.
10052 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
10053 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
10054 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
10055
10056 static void
10057 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
10058 {
10059 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
10060 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
10061 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
10062 : bp_breakpoint);
10063 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
10064 const char *arg_cp = arg;
10065
10066 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
10067 if (arg && probe_linespec_to_ops (&arg_cp) != NULL)
10068 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
10069 else
10070 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
10071
10072 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10073 arg,
10074 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
10075 tempflag, type_wanted,
10076 0 /* Ignore count */,
10077 pending_break_support,
10078 ops,
10079 from_tty,
10080 1 /* enabled */,
10081 0 /* internal */,
10082 0);
10083 }
10084
10085 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
10086
10087 void
10088 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
10089 {
10090 CORE_ADDR pc;
10091
10092 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10093 {
10094 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
10095 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
10096 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
10097 sal->pc = pc;
10098
10099 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
10100 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
10101 if (sal->explicit_line)
10102 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
10103 }
10104
10105 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10106 {
10107 const struct blockvector *bv;
10108 const struct block *b;
10109 struct symbol *sym;
10110
10111 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
10112 if (bv != NULL)
10113 {
10114 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
10115 if (sym != NULL)
10116 {
10117 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
10118 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sal->symtab->objfile, sym);
10119 }
10120 else
10121 {
10122 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
10123 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
10124 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
10125 happen in assembly source). */
10126
10127 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
10128 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
10129
10130 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
10131
10132 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
10133 if (msym.minsym)
10134 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
10135
10136 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10137 }
10138 }
10139 }
10140 }
10141
10142 void
10143 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10144 {
10145 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10146 }
10147
10148 void
10149 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10150 {
10151 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
10152 }
10153
10154 static void
10155 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10156 {
10157 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
10158 }
10159
10160 static void
10161 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10162 {
10163 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
10164 }
10165
10166 static void
10167 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10168 {
10169 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
10170 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
10171 stop at <line>\n"));
10172 }
10173
10174 static void
10175 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10176 {
10177 int badInput = 0;
10178
10179 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
10180 badInput = 1;
10181 else if (*arg != '*')
10182 {
10183 char *argptr = arg;
10184 int hasColon = 0;
10185
10186 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
10187 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
10188 function/method name. */
10189 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10190 {
10191 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10192 argptr++;
10193 }
10194
10195 if (hasColon)
10196 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
10197 else
10198 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
10199 }
10200
10201 if (badInput)
10202 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
10203 else
10204 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10205 }
10206
10207 static void
10208 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10209 {
10210 int badInput = 0;
10211
10212 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
10213 badInput = 1;
10214 else
10215 {
10216 char *argptr = arg;
10217 int hasColon = 0;
10218
10219 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
10220 it is probably a line number. */
10221 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10222 {
10223 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10224 argptr++;
10225 }
10226
10227 if (hasColon)
10228 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
10229 else
10230 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
10231 }
10232
10233 if (badInput)
10234 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
10235 else
10236 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10237 }
10238
10239 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
10240 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
10241 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
10242 line. */
10243
10244 static void
10245 dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10246 {
10247 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10248 arg,
10249 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
10250 0, bp_dprintf,
10251 0 /* Ignore count */,
10252 pending_break_support,
10253 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
10254 from_tty,
10255 1 /* enabled */,
10256 0 /* internal */,
10257 0);
10258 }
10259
10260 static void
10261 agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10262 {
10263 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
10264 }
10265
10266 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
10267 ranged breakpoints. */
10268
10269 static int
10270 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10271 struct address_space *aspace,
10272 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10273 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10274 {
10275 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
10276 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10277 return 0;
10278
10279 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
10280 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
10281 }
10282
10283 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10284 ranged breakpoints. */
10285
10286 static int
10287 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10288 {
10289 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10290 }
10291
10292 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10293 ranged breakpoints. */
10294
10295 static enum print_stop_action
10296 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
10297 {
10298 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10299 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10300 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10301
10302 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10303
10304 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10305 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10306
10307 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
10308 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
10309 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary ranged breakpoint ");
10310 else
10311 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nRanged breakpoint ");
10312 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10313 {
10314 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
10315 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
10316 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
10317 }
10318 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
10319 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
10320
10321 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10322 }
10323
10324 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
10325 ranged breakpoints. */
10326
10327 static void
10328 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10329 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10330 {
10331 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10332 struct value_print_options opts;
10333 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10334
10335 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10336 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10337
10338 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10339
10340 if (opts.addressprint)
10341 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
10342 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
10343 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
10344 annotate_field (5);
10345 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
10346 *last_loc = bl;
10347 }
10348
10349 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10350 ranged breakpoints. */
10351
10352 static void
10353 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10354 struct ui_out *uiout)
10355 {
10356 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
10357 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10358 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
10359 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10360
10361 gdb_assert (bl);
10362
10363 address_start = bl->address;
10364 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
10365
10366 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
10367 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
10368 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
10369 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
10370 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
10371 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10372
10373 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10374 }
10375
10376 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10377 ranged breakpoints. */
10378
10379 static void
10380 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10381 {
10382 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10383 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10384
10385 gdb_assert (bl);
10386 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10387
10388 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10389 return;
10390
10391 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
10392 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
10393 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
10394 }
10395
10396 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10397 ranged breakpoints. */
10398
10399 static void
10400 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10401 {
10402 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s", b->addr_string,
10403 b->addr_string_range_end);
10404 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10405 }
10406
10407 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
10408
10409 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
10410
10411 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
10412 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
10413 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
10414 last instruction of the given line. */
10415
10416 static CORE_ADDR
10417 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
10418 {
10419 CORE_ADDR end;
10420
10421 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
10422 find the address of the end of the given location. */
10423 if (sal.explicit_pc)
10424 end = sal.pc;
10425 else
10426 {
10427 int ret;
10428 CORE_ADDR start;
10429
10430 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
10431 if (!ret)
10432 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10433
10434 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
10435 end--;
10436 }
10437
10438 return end;
10439 }
10440
10441 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
10442
10443 static void
10444 break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10445 {
10446 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start, *addr_string_end;
10447 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
10448 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
10449 CORE_ADDR end;
10450 struct breakpoint *b;
10451 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
10452 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
10453 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
10454
10455 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
10456 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
10457 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
10458
10459 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10460 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10461 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10462 bp_count, 0);
10463 if (can_use_bp < 0)
10464 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10465
10466 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10467 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
10468 error(_("No address range specified."));
10469
10470 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10471
10472 arg_start = arg;
10473 parse_breakpoint_sals (&arg, &canonical_start);
10474
10475 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10476
10477 if (arg[0] != ',')
10478 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10479 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
10480 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10481
10482 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
10483
10484 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
10485 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
10486 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10487
10488 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
10489 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10490 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
10491
10492 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10493 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10494
10495 /* Parse the end location. */
10496
10497 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10498 arg_start = arg;
10499
10500 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10501 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10502 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10503 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10504 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10505 decode_line_full (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10506 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10507 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10508
10509 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10510
10511 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
10512 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10513
10514 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
10515 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
10516 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
10517 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10518
10519 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
10520 addr_string_end = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10521 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_end);
10522
10523 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10524 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10525 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10526
10527 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10528 if (length < 0)
10529 /* Length overflowed. */
10530 error (_("Address range too large."));
10531 else if (length == 1)
10532 {
10533 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10534 the `hbreak' command. */
10535 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
10536
10537 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10538
10539 return;
10540 }
10541
10542 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10543 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10544 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10545 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10546 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10547 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10548 b->addr_string = xstrdup (addr_string_start);
10549 b->addr_string_range_end = xstrdup (addr_string_end);
10550 b->loc->length = length;
10551
10552 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10553
10554 mention (b);
10555 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10556 update_global_location_list (1);
10557 }
10558
10559 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10560 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10561 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10562 zero. */
10563
10564 static int
10565 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10566 {
10567 int i = exp->nelts;
10568
10569 while (i > 0)
10570 {
10571 int oplenp, argsp;
10572
10573 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10574 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10575 i -= oplenp;
10576
10577 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10578 {
10579 case BINOP_ADD:
10580 case BINOP_SUB:
10581 case BINOP_MUL:
10582 case BINOP_DIV:
10583 case BINOP_REM:
10584 case BINOP_MOD:
10585 case BINOP_LSH:
10586 case BINOP_RSH:
10587 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10588 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10589 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10590 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10591 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10592 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10593 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10594 case BINOP_LESS:
10595 case BINOP_GTR:
10596 case BINOP_LEQ:
10597 case BINOP_GEQ:
10598 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10599 case BINOP_COMMA:
10600 case BINOP_EXP:
10601 case BINOP_MIN:
10602 case BINOP_MAX:
10603 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10604 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10605 case TERNOP_COND:
10606 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10607
10608 case OP_LONG:
10609 case OP_DOUBLE:
10610 case OP_DECFLOAT:
10611 case OP_LAST:
10612 case OP_COMPLEX:
10613 case OP_STRING:
10614 case OP_ARRAY:
10615 case OP_TYPE:
10616 case OP_TYPEOF:
10617 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10618 case OP_TYPEID:
10619 case OP_NAME:
10620 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10621
10622 case UNOP_NEG:
10623 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10624 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10625 case UNOP_ADDR:
10626 case UNOP_HIGH:
10627 case UNOP_CAST:
10628
10629 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10630 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10631 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10632 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10633 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10634 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10635 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10636
10637 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10638 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10639 ADDR is. */
10640 break;
10641
10642 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10643 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10644
10645 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10646 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10647 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10648 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10649
10650 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10651 are always constant. */
10652 {
10653 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10654
10655 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10656 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10657 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10658 return 0;
10659 break;
10660 }
10661
10662 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10663 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10664 then it is not a constant. */
10665 default:
10666 return 0;
10667 }
10668 }
10669
10670 return 1;
10671 }
10672
10673 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10674
10675 static void
10676 dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
10677 {
10678 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
10679
10680 xfree (w->cond_exp);
10681 xfree (w->exp);
10682 xfree (w->exp_string);
10683 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
10684 value_free (w->val);
10685
10686 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
10687 }
10688
10689 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10690
10691 static void
10692 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10693 {
10694 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10695
10696 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10697 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10698
10699 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10700 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10701 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10702 are loaded and unloaded.
10703
10704 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10705 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10706 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10707 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10708 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10709 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10710
10711 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10712 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10713 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10714 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10715
10716 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10717 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10718
10719 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10720 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10721 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10722 }
10723
10724 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10725
10726 static int
10727 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10728 {
10729 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10730 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10731
10732 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10733 w->cond_exp);
10734 }
10735
10736 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10737
10738 static int
10739 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10740 {
10741 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10742 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10743
10744 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10745 w->cond_exp);
10746 }
10747
10748 static int
10749 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10750 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10751 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10752 {
10753 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10754 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10755
10756 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10757 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10758 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10759 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10760 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10761 (did not match the data address). */
10762 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10763 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10764 return 0;
10765
10766 return 1;
10767 }
10768
10769 static void
10770 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10771 {
10772 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10773
10774 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10775 }
10776
10777 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10778 hardware watchpoints. */
10779
10780 static int
10781 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10782 {
10783 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10784 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10785
10786 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10787 }
10788
10789 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10790 hardware watchpoints. */
10791
10792 static int
10793 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10794 {
10795 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10796 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10797 }
10798
10799 static enum print_stop_action
10800 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10801 {
10802 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10803 struct breakpoint *b;
10804 struct ui_file *stb;
10805 enum print_stop_action result;
10806 struct watchpoint *w;
10807 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10808
10809 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10810
10811 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10812 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10813
10814 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10815 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10816
10817 switch (b->type)
10818 {
10819 case bp_watchpoint:
10820 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10821 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10822 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10823 ui_out_field_string
10824 (uiout, "reason",
10825 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10826 mention (b);
10827 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10828 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10829 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10830 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10831 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10832 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10833 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10834 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10835 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10836 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10837 break;
10838
10839 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10840 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10841 ui_out_field_string
10842 (uiout, "reason",
10843 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10844 mention (b);
10845 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10846 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10847 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10848 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10849 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10850 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10851 break;
10852
10853 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10854 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10855 {
10856 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10857 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10858 ui_out_field_string
10859 (uiout, "reason",
10860 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10861 mention (b);
10862 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10863 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10864 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10865 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10866 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10867 }
10868 else
10869 {
10870 mention (b);
10871 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10872 ui_out_field_string
10873 (uiout, "reason",
10874 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10875 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10876 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10877 }
10878 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10879 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10880 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10881 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10882 break;
10883 default:
10884 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10885 }
10886
10887 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10888 return result;
10889 }
10890
10891 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10892 watchpoints. */
10893
10894 static void
10895 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10896 {
10897 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10898 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10899 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10900
10901 switch (b->type)
10902 {
10903 case bp_watchpoint:
10904 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
10905 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10906 break;
10907 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10908 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
10909 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10910 break;
10911 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10912 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
10913 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10914 break;
10915 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10916 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10917 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10918 break;
10919 default:
10920 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10921 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10922 }
10923
10924 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10925 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10926 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10927 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10928 }
10929
10930 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10931 watchpoints. */
10932
10933 static void
10934 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10935 {
10936 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10937
10938 switch (b->type)
10939 {
10940 case bp_watchpoint:
10941 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10942 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10943 break;
10944 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10945 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10946 break;
10947 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10948 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10949 break;
10950 default:
10951 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10952 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10953 }
10954
10955 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10956 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10957 }
10958
10959 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10960 watchpoints. */
10961
10962 static int
10963 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10964 {
10965 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10966 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10967 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10968 return 0;
10969
10970 return 1;
10971 }
10972
10973 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10974
10975 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10976
10977 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10978 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10979
10980 static int
10981 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10982 {
10983 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10984
10985 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10986 bl->watchpoint_type);
10987 }
10988
10989 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10990 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10991
10992 static int
10993 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10994 {
10995 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10996
10997 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10998 bl->watchpoint_type);
10999 }
11000
11001 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
11002 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11003
11004 static int
11005 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
11006 {
11007 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
11008
11009 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
11010 }
11011
11012 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
11013 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11014
11015 static int
11016 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
11017 {
11018 return 0;
11019 }
11020
11021 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
11022 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11023
11024 static enum print_stop_action
11025 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
11026 {
11027 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11028 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11029
11030 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11031 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11032
11033 switch (b->type)
11034 {
11035 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11036 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
11037 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11038 ui_out_field_string
11039 (uiout, "reason",
11040 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11041 break;
11042
11043 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11044 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11045 ui_out_field_string
11046 (uiout, "reason",
11047 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11048 break;
11049
11050 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11051 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11052 ui_out_field_string
11053 (uiout, "reason",
11054 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11055 break;
11056 default:
11057 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11058 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11059 }
11060
11061 mention (b);
11062 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
11063 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
11064 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
11065 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11066
11067 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
11068 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
11069 }
11070
11071 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
11072 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11073
11074 static void
11075 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
11076 struct ui_out *uiout)
11077 {
11078 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11079
11080 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11081 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11082
11083 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
11084 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
11085 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11086 }
11087
11088 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
11089 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11090
11091 static void
11092 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
11093 {
11094 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11095 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11096 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
11097
11098 switch (b->type)
11099 {
11100 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11101 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
11102 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
11103 break;
11104 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11105 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
11106 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
11107 break;
11108 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11109 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
11110 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
11111 break;
11112 default:
11113 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11114 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11115 }
11116
11117 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
11118 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11119 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
11120 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
11121 }
11122
11123 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
11124 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11125
11126 static void
11127 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11128 {
11129 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11130 char tmp[40];
11131
11132 switch (b->type)
11133 {
11134 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11135 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11136 break;
11137 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11138 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11139 break;
11140 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11141 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11142 break;
11143 default:
11144 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11145 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11146 }
11147
11148 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
11149 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
11150 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11151 }
11152
11153 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
11154
11155 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11156
11157 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
11158
11159 static int
11160 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
11161 {
11162 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11163 }
11164
11165 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
11166 hw_read: watch read,
11167 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
11168 static void
11169 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
11170 int just_location, int internal)
11171 {
11172 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11173 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
11174 struct expression *exp;
11175 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
11176 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
11177 struct frame_info *frame;
11178 const char *exp_start = NULL;
11179 const char *exp_end = NULL;
11180 const char *tok, *end_tok;
11181 int toklen = -1;
11182 const char *cond_start = NULL;
11183 const char *cond_end = NULL;
11184 enum bptype bp_type;
11185 int thread = -1;
11186 int pc = 0;
11187 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
11188 the hardware watchpoint. */
11189 int use_mask = 0;
11190 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
11191 struct watchpoint *w;
11192 char *expression;
11193 struct cleanup *back_to;
11194
11195 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
11196 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
11197 {
11198 const char *value_start;
11199
11200 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
11201
11202 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
11203 of the arguments string. */
11204 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
11205 {
11206 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
11207 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11208 tok--;
11209
11210 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
11211 This is the value of the parameter. */
11212 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11213 tok--;
11214 value_start = tok + 1;
11215
11216 /* Skip whitespace. */
11217 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11218 tok--;
11219
11220 end_tok = tok;
11221
11222 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
11223 This is the parameter itself. */
11224 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11225 tok--;
11226 tok++;
11227 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
11228
11229 if (toklen == 6 && !strncmp (tok, "thread", 6))
11230 {
11231 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
11232 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
11233 only in a specific thread. */
11234 char *endp;
11235
11236 if (thread != -1)
11237 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
11238
11239 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
11240 thread = strtol (value_start, &endp, 0);
11241
11242 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
11243 thread ID. */
11244 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
11245 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), value_start);
11246
11247 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
11248 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
11249 invalid_thread_id_error (thread);
11250 }
11251 else if (toklen == 4 && !strncmp (tok, "mask", 4))
11252 {
11253 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
11254 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
11255 facility. */
11256 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
11257
11258 if (use_mask)
11259 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
11260
11261 use_mask = just_location = 1;
11262
11263 mark = value_mark ();
11264 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
11265 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
11266 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11267 }
11268 else
11269 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
11270 break;
11271
11272 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
11273 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
11274 exp_end = tok;
11275 }
11276 }
11277 else
11278 exp_end = arg;
11279
11280 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
11281 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
11282 ARG. */
11283 innermost_block = NULL;
11284 expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg);
11285 back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression);
11286 exp_start = arg = expression;
11287 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
11288 exp_end = arg;
11289 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
11290 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
11291 prettier. */
11292 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
11293 --exp_end;
11294
11295 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
11296 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
11297 {
11298 int len;
11299
11300 len = exp_end - exp_start;
11301 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
11302 len--;
11303 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
11304 }
11305
11306 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11307 mark = value_mark ();
11308 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
11309
11310 if (just_location)
11311 {
11312 int ret;
11313
11314 exp_valid_block = NULL;
11315 val = value_addr (result);
11316 release_value (val);
11317 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11318
11319 if (use_mask)
11320 {
11321 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
11322 mask);
11323 if (ret == -1)
11324 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
11325 else if (ret == -2)
11326 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
11327 }
11328 }
11329 else if (val != NULL)
11330 release_value (val);
11331
11332 tok = skip_spaces_const (arg);
11333 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
11334
11335 toklen = end_tok - tok;
11336 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
11337 {
11338 struct expression *cond;
11339
11340 innermost_block = NULL;
11341 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
11342 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
11343
11344 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
11345 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
11346 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11347
11348 xfree (cond);
11349 cond_end = tok;
11350 }
11351 if (*tok)
11352 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
11353
11354 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
11355
11356 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
11357 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
11358 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
11359 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
11360 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
11361 {
11362 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
11363 {
11364 scope_breakpoint
11365 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11366 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
11367 bp_watchpoint_scope,
11368 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
11369
11370 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11371
11372 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
11373 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
11374
11375 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
11376 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11377
11378 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
11379 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
11380 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11381 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
11382 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11383 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
11384 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
11385 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
11386 scope_breakpoint->type);
11387 }
11388 }
11389
11390 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
11391 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
11392 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
11393 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
11394
11395 if (accessflag == hw_read)
11396 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
11397 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
11398 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
11399 else
11400 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
11401
11402 w = XCNEW (struct watchpoint);
11403 b = &w->base;
11404 if (use_mask)
11405 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11406 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11407 else
11408 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11409 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11410 b->thread = thread;
11411 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
11412 b->pspace = current_program_space;
11413 w->exp = exp;
11414 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
11415 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
11416 if (just_location)
11417 {
11418 struct type *t = value_type (val);
11419 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
11420 char *name;
11421
11422 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
11423 name = type_to_string (t);
11424
11425 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
11426 core_addr_to_string (addr));
11427 xfree (name);
11428
11429 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
11430 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
11431
11432 /* The above expression is in C. */
11433 b->language = language_c;
11434 }
11435 else
11436 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
11437
11438 if (use_mask)
11439 {
11440 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
11441 }
11442 else
11443 {
11444 w->val = val;
11445 w->val_valid = 1;
11446 }
11447
11448 if (cond_start)
11449 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
11450 else
11451 b->cond_string = 0;
11452
11453 if (frame)
11454 {
11455 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
11456 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
11457 }
11458 else
11459 {
11460 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
11461 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
11462 }
11463
11464 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
11465 {
11466 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
11467 need to act on them together. */
11468 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
11469 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
11470 }
11471
11472 if (!just_location)
11473 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11474
11475 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11476 {
11477 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
11478 that should be inserted. */
11479 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
11480 }
11481 if (e.reason < 0)
11482 {
11483 delete_breakpoint (b);
11484 throw_exception (e);
11485 }
11486
11487 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
11488 do_cleanups (back_to);
11489 }
11490
11491 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
11492 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
11493
11494 static int
11495 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
11496 {
11497 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
11498 struct value *head = v;
11499
11500 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
11501 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
11502 return 0;
11503
11504 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
11505 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
11506 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
11507 hardware watchpoint.
11508
11509 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
11510 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
11511 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
11512 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
11513 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
11514 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
11515 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
11516 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
11517 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
11518
11519 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
11520 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
11521 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
11522 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
11523 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
11524 {
11525 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11526 {
11527 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11528 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11529 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11530 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11531 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11532 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11533 ;
11534 else
11535 {
11536 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11537 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11538 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11539
11540 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11541 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11542 middle of some value chain. */
11543 if (v == head
11544 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11545 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11546 {
11547 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11548 int len;
11549 int num_regs;
11550
11551 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11552 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11553 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11554
11555 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11556 if (!num_regs)
11557 return 0;
11558 else
11559 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11560 }
11561 }
11562 }
11563 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11564 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11565 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11566 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11567 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11568 }
11569
11570 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11571 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11572 return found_memory_cnt;
11573 }
11574
11575 void
11576 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11577 {
11578 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11579 }
11580
11581 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11582 calls watch_command_1. */
11583
11584 static void
11585 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11586 {
11587 int just_location = 0;
11588
11589 if (arg
11590 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11591 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11592 {
11593 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11594 just_location = 1;
11595 }
11596
11597 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11598 }
11599
11600 static void
11601 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11602 {
11603 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11604 }
11605
11606 void
11607 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11608 {
11609 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11610 }
11611
11612 static void
11613 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11614 {
11615 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11616 }
11617
11618 void
11619 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11620 {
11621 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11622 }
11623
11624 static void
11625 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11626 {
11627 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11628 }
11629 \f
11630
11631 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
11632 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
11633
11634 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
11635 {
11636 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
11637 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
11638 int thread_num;
11639 };
11640
11641 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
11642 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
11643 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
11644 command. */
11645 static void
11646 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg, int err)
11647 {
11648 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
11649
11650 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
11651 if (a->breakpoint2)
11652 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
11653 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (a->thread_num);
11654 }
11655
11656 void
11657 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11658 {
11659 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11660 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11661 struct frame_info *frame;
11662 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11663 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11664 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11665 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
11666 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
11667 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11668 int thread;
11669 struct thread_info *tp;
11670
11671 clear_proceed_status (0);
11672
11673 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11674 this function. */
11675
11676 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
11677 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11678 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11679 get_last_displayed_line ());
11680 else
11681 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11682 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
11683
11684 if (sals.nelts != 1)
11685 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11686
11687 sal = sals.sals[0];
11688 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
11689
11690 if (*arg)
11691 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11692
11693 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11694
11695 tp = inferior_thread ();
11696 thread = tp->num;
11697
11698 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11699
11700 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11701 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11702 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11703 that. */
11704
11705 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11706 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11707 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11708 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11709
11710 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11711 one. */
11712
11713 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11714 {
11715 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11716
11717 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11718 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11719 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11720 sal2,
11721 caller_frame_id,
11722 bp_until);
11723 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
11724
11725 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11726 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11727 }
11728
11729 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11730 frame = NULL;
11731
11732 if (anywhere)
11733 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11734 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11735 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11736 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11737 else
11738 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11739 only at the very same frame. */
11740 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11741 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11742 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
11743
11744 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
11745
11746 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has
11747 actually managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to
11748 be deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already
11749 stopped and delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
11750
11751 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
11752 {
11753 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
11754 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
11755
11756 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
11757 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
11758 args->thread_num = thread;
11759
11760 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11761 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
11762 until_break_command_continuation, args,
11763 xfree);
11764 }
11765 else
11766 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11767 }
11768
11769 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11770 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11771
11772 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11773 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11774 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11775 if clause in the arg string. */
11776
11777 char *
11778 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11779 {
11780 char *cond_string;
11781
11782 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11783 return NULL;
11784
11785 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11786 (*arg) += 2;
11787
11788 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11789 condition string. */
11790 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11791 cond_string = *arg;
11792
11793 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11794 string. */
11795 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11796
11797 return cond_string;
11798 }
11799
11800 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11801 process start/exit, etc. */
11802
11803 typedef enum
11804 {
11805 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11806 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11807 }
11808 catch_fork_kind;
11809
11810 static void
11811 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11812 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11813 {
11814 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11815 char *cond_string = NULL;
11816 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11817 int tempflag;
11818
11819 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11820 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11821 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11822
11823 if (!arg)
11824 arg = "";
11825 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11826
11827 /* The allowed syntax is:
11828 catch [v]fork
11829 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11830
11831 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11832 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11833
11834 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11835 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11836
11837 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11838 and enable reporting of such events. */
11839 switch (fork_kind)
11840 {
11841 case catch_fork_temporary:
11842 case catch_fork_permanent:
11843 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11844 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11845 break;
11846 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11847 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11848 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11849 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11850 break;
11851 default:
11852 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11853 break;
11854 }
11855 }
11856
11857 static void
11858 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11859 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11860 {
11861 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11862 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11863 int tempflag;
11864 char *cond_string = NULL;
11865
11866 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11867
11868 if (!arg)
11869 arg = "";
11870 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11871
11872 /* The allowed syntax is:
11873 catch exec
11874 catch exec if <cond>
11875
11876 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11877 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11878
11879 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11880 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11881
11882 c = XNEW (struct exec_catchpoint);
11883 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11884 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11885 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11886
11887 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11888 }
11889
11890 void
11891 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11892 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11893 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11894 char *addr_string,
11895 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11896 int tempflag,
11897 int enabled,
11898 int from_tty)
11899 {
11900 if (from_tty)
11901 {
11902 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11903 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11904 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11905
11906 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11907 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11908 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11909 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11910 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11911 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11912 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11913 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11914 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11915 enough for now, though. */
11916 }
11917
11918 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11919
11920 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11921 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11922 b->addr_string = addr_string;
11923 b->language = language_ada;
11924 }
11925
11926 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
11927 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
11928 static VEC(int) *
11929 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
11930 {
11931 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
11932 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (int), &result);
11933
11934 while (*arg != '\0')
11935 {
11936 int i, syscall_number;
11937 char *endptr;
11938 char cur_name[128];
11939 struct syscall s;
11940
11941 /* Skip whitespace. */
11942 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11943
11944 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
11945 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
11946 cur_name[i] = '\0';
11947 arg += i;
11948
11949 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
11950 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
11951 if (*endptr == '\0')
11952 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
11953 else
11954 {
11955 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
11956 to a number. */
11957 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
11958
11959 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
11960 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning,
11961 because GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no
11962 syscall number to be caught. */
11963 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
11964 }
11965
11966 /* Ok, it's valid. */
11967 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
11968 }
11969
11970 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
11971 return result;
11972 }
11973
11974 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
11975
11976 static void
11977 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11978 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11979 {
11980 int tempflag;
11981 VEC(int) *filter;
11982 struct syscall s;
11983 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11984
11985 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
11986 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
11987 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
11988 this architecture yet."));
11989
11990 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11991
11992 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11993
11994 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
11995 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
11996 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
11997 for his/her architecture. */
11998 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
11999
12000 /* The allowed syntax is:
12001 catch syscall
12002 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
12003
12004 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
12005
12006 if (arg != NULL)
12007 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
12008 else
12009 filter = NULL;
12010
12011 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
12012 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
12013 }
12014
12015 static void
12016 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12017 {
12018 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
12019 }
12020 \f
12021
12022 static void
12023 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12024 {
12025 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
12026 }
12027
12028 /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
12029
12030 static int
12031 compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
12032 {
12033 const breakpoint_p *ba = a;
12034 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
12035 const breakpoint_p *bb = b;
12036 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
12037
12038 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
12039 return -1;
12040 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
12041 return 1;
12042
12043 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
12044 the number 0. */
12045 if (ua < ub)
12046 return -1;
12047 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
12048 }
12049
12050 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
12051
12052 static void
12053 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12054 {
12055 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
12056 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
12057 int ix;
12058 int default_match;
12059 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
12060 struct symtab_and_line sal;
12061 int i;
12062 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
12063
12064 if (arg)
12065 {
12066 sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
12067 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
12068 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
12069 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12070 default_match = 0;
12071 }
12072 else
12073 {
12074 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
12075 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
12076 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12077 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
12078
12079 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
12080 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
12081 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
12082 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
12083 if (sal.symtab == 0)
12084 error (_("No source file specified."));
12085
12086 sals.sals[0] = sal;
12087 sals.nelts = 1;
12088
12089 default_match = 1;
12090 }
12091
12092 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
12093 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
12094 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
12095 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
12096
12097 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
12098 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
12099 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
12100 due to optimization, all in one block.
12101
12102 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
12103 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
12104 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
12105 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
12106 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
12107 to support that. */
12108
12109 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
12110 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
12111 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
12112 breakpoint. */
12113
12114 found = NULL;
12115 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
12116 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
12117 {
12118 const char *sal_fullname;
12119
12120 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
12121 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
12122 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
12123 or at default pc.
12124
12125 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
12126
12127 0 1 pc
12128 1 1 pc _and_ line
12129 0 0 line
12130 1 0 <can't happen> */
12131
12132 sal = sals.sals[i];
12133 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
12134 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
12135
12136 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
12137 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12138 {
12139 int match = 0;
12140 /* Are we going to delete b? */
12141 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
12142 {
12143 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12144 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12145 {
12146 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
12147 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
12148 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
12149 && sal.pc
12150 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
12151 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
12152 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
12153 || loc->section == sal.section));
12154 int line_match = 0;
12155
12156 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
12157 && loc->symtab != NULL
12158 && sal_fullname != NULL
12159 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
12160 && loc->line_number == sal.line
12161 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
12162 sal_fullname) == 0)
12163 line_match = 1;
12164
12165 if (pc_match || line_match)
12166 {
12167 match = 1;
12168 break;
12169 }
12170 }
12171 }
12172
12173 if (match)
12174 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
12175 }
12176 }
12177
12178 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
12179 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
12180 {
12181 if (arg)
12182 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
12183 else
12184 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
12185 }
12186
12187 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
12188 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
12189 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
12190 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
12191 compare_breakpoints);
12192 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
12193 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
12194 {
12195 if (b == prev)
12196 {
12197 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
12198 --ix;
12199 }
12200 }
12201
12202 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
12203 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
12204 if (from_tty)
12205 {
12206 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
12207 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
12208 else
12209 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
12210 }
12211
12212 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
12213 {
12214 if (from_tty)
12215 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
12216 delete_breakpoint (b);
12217 }
12218 if (from_tty)
12219 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
12220
12221 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12222 }
12223 \f
12224 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
12225 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
12226 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
12227
12228 void
12229 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
12230 {
12231 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
12232
12233 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
12234 if (bs->breakpoint_at
12235 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
12236 && bs->stop)
12237 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
12238
12239 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
12240 {
12241 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
12242 delete_breakpoint (b);
12243 }
12244 }
12245
12246 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
12247 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
12248 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
12249 secondarily by ordering first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and
12250 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
12251 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
12252
12253 static int
12254 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
12255 {
12256 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
12257 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
12258 /* A and B come from existing breakpoints having non-NULL OWNER. */
12259 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
12260 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
12261
12262 if (a->address != b->address)
12263 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
12264
12265 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
12266 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
12267 grouped. */
12268
12269 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
12270 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
12271 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
12272
12273 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
12274 if (a_perm != b_perm)
12275 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
12276
12277 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
12278 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
12279 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
12280
12281 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
12282 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
12283 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
12284
12285 return (a > b) - (a < b);
12286 }
12287
12288 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
12289 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
12290 content of the bp_location array. */
12291
12292 static void
12293 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
12294 {
12295 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
12296
12297 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
12298 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
12299
12300 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
12301 {
12302 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
12303
12304 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
12305 continue;
12306
12307 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
12308 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
12309
12310 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
12311 addr = bl->address - start;
12312 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
12313 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
12314
12315 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
12316
12317 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
12318 addr = end - bl->address;
12319 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
12320 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
12321 }
12322 }
12323
12324 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
12325
12326 static void
12327 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
12328 {
12329 struct breakpoint *b;
12330 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12331
12332 if (!target_can_download_tracepoint ())
12333 return;
12334
12335 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
12336
12337 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
12338 {
12339 struct bp_location *bl;
12340 struct tracepoint *t;
12341 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
12342
12343 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
12344 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
12345 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
12346 continue;
12347
12348 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
12349 {
12350 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
12351 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
12352 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
12353 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
12354 continue;
12355
12356 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
12357
12358 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
12359
12360 bl->inserted = 1;
12361 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
12362 }
12363 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12364 t->number_on_target = b->number;
12365 if (bp_location_downloaded)
12366 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
12367 }
12368
12369 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12370 }
12371
12372 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
12373
12374 static void
12375 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
12376 {
12377 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
12378 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
12379 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
12380 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
12381
12382 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
12383 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
12384 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
12385 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
12386 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
12387
12388 left->inserted = right->inserted;
12389 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
12390 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
12391 left->target_info = right->target_info;
12392 right->inserted = left_inserted;
12393 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
12394 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
12395 right->target_info = left_target_info;
12396 }
12397
12398 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
12399 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
12400 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
12401 the target. */
12402
12403 static void
12404 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
12405 {
12406 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
12407 struct bp_location *loc;
12408 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
12409 int pspace_num;
12410
12411 address = bl->address;
12412 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
12413
12414 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
12415 evaluating conditions and if the user has
12416 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
12417 side. */
12418 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
12419 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
12420 return;
12421
12422 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
12423 the same program space as the location
12424 as "its condition has changed". We need to
12425 update the conditions on the target's side. */
12426 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
12427 {
12428 loc = *loc2p;
12429
12430 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
12431 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
12432 continue;
12433
12434 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
12435 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
12436 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
12437 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
12438 that have already been marked. */
12439 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
12440
12441 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
12442 it later on. */
12443 if (loc->cond_bytecode)
12444 {
12445 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
12446 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
12447 }
12448 }
12449 }
12450
12451 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
12452 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
12453 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
12454 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
12455 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
12456 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
12457 returns true on them.
12458
12459 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
12460 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
12461 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
12462 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
12463 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
12464 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
12465
12466 static void
12467 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
12468 {
12469 struct breakpoint *b;
12470 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
12471 struct cleanup *cleanups;
12472 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
12473 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
12474 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
12475 int last_pspace_num = -1;
12476
12477 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
12478 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
12479 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
12480 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
12481 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
12482 once. */
12483 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
12484 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
12485 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
12486 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
12487
12488 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
12489 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
12490 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
12491 unsigned old_location_count;
12492
12493 old_location = bp_location;
12494 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
12495 bp_location = NULL;
12496 bp_location_count = 0;
12497 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
12498
12499 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12500 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12501 bp_location_count++;
12502
12503 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
12504 locp = bp_location;
12505 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12506 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12507 *locp++ = loc;
12508 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
12509 bp_location_compare);
12510
12511 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
12512
12513 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
12514 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
12515 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
12516 if there's another location at the same address (previously
12517 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
12518 location.
12519
12520 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
12521 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
12522
12523 locp = bp_location;
12524 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
12525 old_locp++)
12526 {
12527 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
12528 struct bp_location **loc2p;
12529
12530 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12531 not, we have to free it. */
12532 int found_object = 0;
12533 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12534 int keep_in_target = 0;
12535 int removed = 0;
12536
12537 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12538 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12539 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12540 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12541 locp++;
12542
12543 for (loc2p = locp;
12544 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12545 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12546 loc2p++)
12547 {
12548 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12549 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12550 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12551 place there. */
12552 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12553 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12554 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12555 {
12556 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12557 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12558 }
12559
12560 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12561 found_object = 1;
12562 }
12563
12564 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12565 have to go through updates again. */
12566 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12567
12568 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12569 if (!found_object)
12570 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12571
12572 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12573 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12574 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12575 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12576 at certain location is not inserted. */
12577
12578 if (old_loc->inserted)
12579 {
12580 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12581 it. */
12582
12583 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12584 {
12585 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12586 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12587 keep_in_target = 1;
12588 }
12589 else
12590 {
12591 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12592 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12593 remove its target-side condition. */
12594
12595 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12596 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12597 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12598 this one from the target. */
12599
12600 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12601 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12602 {
12603 for (loc2p = locp;
12604 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12605 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12606 loc2p++)
12607 {
12608 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12609
12610 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12611 {
12612 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12613 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12614 supported, but the latter are. */
12615 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12616 {
12617 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12618 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12619 }
12620
12621 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12622 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12623 unduplicated. */
12624 if (loc2 != old_loc
12625 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12626 {
12627 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12628 keep_in_target = 1;
12629 break;
12630 }
12631 }
12632 }
12633 }
12634 }
12635
12636 if (!keep_in_target)
12637 {
12638 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
12639 {
12640 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12641 this location on the global list, and try to
12642 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12643 reason why we will succeed next time.
12644
12645 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12646 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12647 only after calling us. */
12648 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12649 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12650 old_loc->owner->number);
12651 }
12652 removed = 1;
12653 }
12654 }
12655
12656 if (!found_object)
12657 {
12658 if (removed && non_stop
12659 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
12660 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12661 {
12662 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12663 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12664 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12665 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12666 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12667 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12668 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12669 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12670 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12671 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12672 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12673 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12674 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12675 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12676 SIGTRAP.
12677
12678 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12679 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12680
12681 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12682 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12683 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12684 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12685 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12686 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12687 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12688 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12689 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12690 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12691 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12692 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12693 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12694 thread_count.
12695
12696 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12697 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12698 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12699 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12700
12701 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12702 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12703 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12704 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12705 traps we can no longer explain. */
12706
12707 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12708 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12709
12710 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12711 }
12712 else
12713 {
12714 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12715 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12716 }
12717 }
12718 }
12719
12720 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12721 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12722 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12723 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12724 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12725 are sorted first for the same address.
12726
12727 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12728 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12729
12730 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12731 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12732 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12733 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12734 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12735 {
12736 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12737 non-NULL. */
12738 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12739 b = loc->owner;
12740
12741 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12742 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12743 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12744 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12745 `struct bp_location'. */
12746 || is_tracepoint (b))
12747 {
12748 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12749 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12750 continue;
12751 }
12752
12753 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
12754 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
12755 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12756 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
12757 "actually inserted"));
12758
12759 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12760 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12761 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12762 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12763 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12764 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12765 else
12766 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12767
12768 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12769 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12770 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12771 {
12772 *loc_first_p = loc;
12773 loc->duplicate = 0;
12774
12775 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12776 {
12777 loc->needs_update = 1;
12778 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12779 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12780 }
12781 continue;
12782 }
12783
12784
12785 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12786 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12787 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12788 if (loc->inserted)
12789 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12790 loc->duplicate = 1;
12791
12792 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12793 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12794
12795 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
12796 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
12797 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12798 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
12799 "a permanent breakpoint"));
12800 }
12801
12802 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ()
12803 && (have_live_inferiors ()
12804 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))))
12805 {
12806 if (should_insert)
12807 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12808 else
12809 {
12810 /* Though should_insert is false, we may need to update conditions
12811 on the target's side if it is evaluating such conditions. We
12812 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12813 "needs_update". */
12814 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12815 }
12816 }
12817
12818 if (should_insert)
12819 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12820
12821 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12822 }
12823
12824 void
12825 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12826 {
12827 struct bp_location *loc;
12828 int ix;
12829
12830 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12831 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12832 {
12833 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12834 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12835 --ix;
12836 }
12837 }
12838
12839 static void
12840 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
12841 {
12842 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
12843
12844 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12845 update_global_location_list (inserting);
12846 }
12847
12848 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12849
12850 static void
12851 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12852 {
12853 bpstat bs;
12854
12855 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12856 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12857 {
12858 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12859 bs->old_val = NULL;
12860 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12861 }
12862 }
12863
12864 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12865 static int
12866 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12867 {
12868 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
12869
12870 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12871 return 0;
12872 }
12873
12874 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12875 callbacks. */
12876
12877 static void
12878 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12879 {
12880 struct value_print_options opts;
12881
12882 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12883
12884 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12885 single string. */
12886 if (b->loc == NULL)
12887 {
12888 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
12889 }
12890 else
12891 {
12892 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12893 {
12894 printf_filtered (" at ");
12895 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12896 gdb_stdout);
12897 }
12898 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12899 {
12900 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12901 more nicely. */
12902 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12903 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12904 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12905 b->loc->line_number);
12906 else
12907 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12908 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12909 real situation somewhat. */
12910 printf_filtered (": %s.", b->addr_string);
12911 }
12912
12913 if (b->loc->next)
12914 {
12915 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12916 int n = 0;
12917 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12918 ++n;
12919 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12920 }
12921 }
12922 }
12923
12924 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12925
12926 static void
12927 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12928 {
12929 xfree (self->cond);
12930 if (self->cond_bytecode)
12931 free_agent_expr (self->cond_bytecode);
12932 xfree (self->function_name);
12933
12934 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.conditions);
12935 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.tcommands);
12936 }
12937
12938 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12939 {
12940 bp_location_dtor
12941 };
12942
12943 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
12944 inherit from. */
12945
12946 static void
12947 base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12948 {
12949 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
12950 xfree (self->cond_string);
12951 xfree (self->extra_string);
12952 xfree (self->addr_string);
12953 xfree (self->filter);
12954 xfree (self->addr_string_range_end);
12955 }
12956
12957 static struct bp_location *
12958 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12959 {
12960 struct bp_location *loc;
12961
12962 loc = XNEW (struct bp_location);
12963 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
12964 return loc;
12965 }
12966
12967 static void
12968 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12969 {
12970 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12971 }
12972
12973 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12974 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12975
12976 static int
12977 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12978 {
12979 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12980 }
12981
12982 static int
12983 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12984 {
12985 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12986 }
12987
12988 static int
12989 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12990 struct address_space *aspace,
12991 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12992 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12993 {
12994 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12995 }
12996
12997 static void
12998 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12999 {
13000 /* Always stop. */
13001 }
13002
13003 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
13004 errors. */
13005
13006 static int
13007 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
13008 {
13009 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13010 }
13011
13012 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
13013 errors. */
13014
13015 static int
13016 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13017 {
13018 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13019 }
13020
13021 static enum print_stop_action
13022 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
13023 {
13024 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13025 }
13026
13027 static void
13028 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13029 struct ui_out *uiout)
13030 {
13031 /* nothing */
13032 }
13033
13034 static void
13035 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13036 {
13037 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13038 }
13039
13040 static void
13041 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
13042 {
13043 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13044 }
13045
13046 static void
13047 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13048 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13049 enum bptype type_wanted,
13050 char *addr_start,
13051 char **copy_arg)
13052 {
13053 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13054 }
13055
13056 static void
13057 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13058 struct linespec_result *c,
13059 char *cond_string,
13060 char *extra_string,
13061 enum bptype type_wanted,
13062 enum bpdisp disposition,
13063 int thread,
13064 int task, int ignore_count,
13065 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
13066 int from_tty, int enabled,
13067 int internal, unsigned flags)
13068 {
13069 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13070 }
13071
13072 static void
13073 base_breakpoint_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13074 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13075 {
13076 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13077 }
13078
13079 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
13080
13081 static int
13082 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
13083 {
13084 return 1;
13085 }
13086
13087 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
13088
13089 static void
13090 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13091 {
13092 /* Nothing to do. */
13093 }
13094
13095 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
13096 {
13097 base_breakpoint_dtor,
13098 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
13099 base_breakpoint_re_set,
13100 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
13101 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
13102 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
13103 base_breakpoint_check_status,
13104 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
13105 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
13106 base_breakpoint_print_it,
13107 NULL,
13108 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
13109 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
13110 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
13111 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_address,
13112 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
13113 base_breakpoint_decode_linespec,
13114 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
13115 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
13116 };
13117
13118 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
13119
13120 static void
13121 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13122 {
13123 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
13124 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
13125 {
13126 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
13127 delete_breakpoint (b);
13128 return;
13129 }
13130
13131 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13132 }
13133
13134 /* Copy SRC's shadow buffer and whatever else we'd set if we actually
13135 inserted DEST, so we can remove it later, in case SRC is removed
13136 first. */
13137
13138 static void
13139 bp_target_info_copy_insertion_state (struct bp_target_info *dest,
13140 const struct bp_target_info *src)
13141 {
13142 dest->shadow_len = src->shadow_len;
13143 memcpy (dest->shadow_contents, src->shadow_contents, src->shadow_len);
13144 dest->placed_size = src->placed_size;
13145 }
13146
13147 static int
13148 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13149 {
13150 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13151 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
13152 &bl->target_info);
13153 else
13154 {
13155 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = &bl->target_info;
13156 int ret;
13157 int sss_slot;
13158
13159 /* There is no need to insert a breakpoint if an unconditional
13160 raw/sss breakpoint is already inserted at that location. */
13161 sss_slot = find_single_step_breakpoint (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
13162 bp_tgt->placed_address);
13163 if (sss_slot >= 0)
13164 {
13165 struct bp_target_info *sss_bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[sss_slot];
13166
13167 bp_target_info_copy_insertion_state (bp_tgt, sss_bp_tgt);
13168 return 0;
13169 }
13170
13171 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, bp_tgt);
13172 }
13173 }
13174
13175 static int
13176 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13177 {
13178 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13179 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13180 else
13181 {
13182 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = &bl->target_info;
13183 struct address_space *aspace = bp_tgt->placed_address_space;
13184 CORE_ADDR address = bp_tgt->placed_address;
13185
13186 /* Only remove the breakpoint if there is no raw/sss breakpoint
13187 still inserted at this location. Otherwise, we would be
13188 effectively disabling the raw/sss breakpoint. */
13189 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, address))
13190 return 0;
13191
13192 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, bp_tgt);
13193 }
13194 }
13195
13196 static int
13197 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13198 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13199 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13200 {
13201 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
13202 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
13203 return 0;
13204
13205 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
13206 aspace, bp_addr))
13207 return 0;
13208
13209 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
13210 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
13211 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
13212 return 0;
13213
13214 return 1;
13215 }
13216
13217 static int
13218 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13219 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13220 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13221 {
13222 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
13223 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
13224 {
13225 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
13226 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
13227 be set at the same address. */
13228 return 0;
13229 }
13230
13231 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
13232 }
13233
13234 static int
13235 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13236 {
13237 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
13238
13239 return 1;
13240 }
13241
13242 static enum print_stop_action
13243 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13244 {
13245 struct breakpoint *b;
13246 const struct bp_location *bl;
13247 int bp_temp;
13248 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13249
13250 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
13251
13252 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
13253 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13254
13255 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
13256 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
13257 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
13258 bl->address,
13259 b->number, 1);
13260 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
13261 if (bp_temp)
13262 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
13263 else
13264 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
13265 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13266 {
13267 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
13268 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
13269 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
13270 }
13271 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
13272 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
13273
13274 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
13275 }
13276
13277 static void
13278 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13279 {
13280 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13281 return;
13282
13283 switch (b->type)
13284 {
13285 case bp_breakpoint:
13286 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
13287 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
13288 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
13289 else
13290 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
13291 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13292 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
13293 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
13294 break;
13295 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
13296 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
13297 break;
13298 case bp_dprintf:
13299 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
13300 break;
13301 }
13302
13303 say_where (b);
13304 }
13305
13306 static void
13307 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13308 {
13309 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13310 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
13311 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
13312 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
13313 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
13314 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13315 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
13316 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13317 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
13318 else
13319 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13320 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
13321
13322 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->addr_string);
13323 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13324 }
13325
13326 static void
13327 bkpt_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13328 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13329 enum bptype type_wanted,
13330 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13331 {
13332 create_sals_from_address_default (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13333 addr_start, copy_arg);
13334 }
13335
13336 static void
13337 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13338 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13339 char *cond_string,
13340 char *extra_string,
13341 enum bptype type_wanted,
13342 enum bpdisp disposition,
13343 int thread,
13344 int task, int ignore_count,
13345 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13346 int from_tty, int enabled,
13347 int internal, unsigned flags)
13348 {
13349 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13350 cond_string, extra_string,
13351 type_wanted,
13352 disposition, thread, task,
13353 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13354 enabled, internal, flags);
13355 }
13356
13357 static void
13358 bkpt_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13359 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13360 {
13361 decode_linespec_default (b, s, sals);
13362 }
13363
13364 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
13365
13366 static void
13367 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13368 {
13369 switch (b->type)
13370 {
13371 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
13372 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
13373 case bp_overlay_event:
13374 case bp_longjmp_master:
13375 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13376 case bp_exception_master:
13377 delete_breakpoint (b);
13378 break;
13379
13380 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
13381 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
13382 case bp_shlib_event:
13383
13384 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
13385 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
13386 case bp_thread_event:
13387 break;
13388 }
13389 }
13390
13391 static void
13392 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13393 {
13394 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
13395 {
13396 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
13397 events. This allows the user to get control and place
13398 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
13399 objects (among other things). */
13400 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
13401 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
13402 }
13403 else
13404 bs->stop = 0;
13405 }
13406
13407 static enum print_stop_action
13408 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13409 {
13410 struct breakpoint *b;
13411
13412 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13413
13414 switch (b->type)
13415 {
13416 case bp_shlib_event:
13417 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
13418 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
13419 to shlib event" message.) */
13420 print_solib_event (0);
13421 break;
13422
13423 case bp_thread_event:
13424 /* Not sure how we will get here.
13425 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
13426 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13427 break;
13428
13429 case bp_overlay_event:
13430 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
13431 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13432 break;
13433
13434 case bp_longjmp_master:
13435 /* These should never be enabled. */
13436 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13437 break;
13438
13439 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13440 /* These should never be enabled. */
13441 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
13442 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13443 break;
13444
13445 case bp_exception_master:
13446 /* These should never be enabled. */
13447 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
13448 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13449 break;
13450 }
13451
13452 return PRINT_NOTHING;
13453 }
13454
13455 static void
13456 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13457 {
13458 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13459 }
13460
13461 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
13462
13463 static void
13464 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13465 {
13466 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
13467 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
13468 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
13469 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
13470 }
13471
13472 static void
13473 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13474 {
13475 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
13476 }
13477
13478 static enum print_stop_action
13479 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13480 {
13481 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13482
13483 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13484 {
13485 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13486
13487 switch (b->type)
13488 {
13489 case bp_finish:
13490 ui_out_field_string
13491 (uiout, "reason",
13492 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
13493 break;
13494
13495 case bp_until:
13496 ui_out_field_string
13497 (uiout, "reason",
13498 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
13499 break;
13500 }
13501 }
13502
13503 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
13504 }
13505
13506 static void
13507 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13508 {
13509 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13510 }
13511
13512 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
13513
13514 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
13515 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
13516
13517 static void
13518 longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13519 {
13520 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_id (self->thread);
13521
13522 if (tp)
13523 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
13524
13525 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
13526 }
13527
13528 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
13529
13530 static int
13531 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13532 {
13533 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
13534
13535 if (v == 0)
13536 {
13537 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
13538 if needed. */
13539 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13540 bl->probe.objfile,
13541 bl->gdbarch);
13542 }
13543
13544 return v;
13545 }
13546
13547 static int
13548 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13549 {
13550 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
13551 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13552 bl->probe.objfile,
13553 bl->gdbarch);
13554
13555 return bkpt_remove_location (bl);
13556 }
13557
13558 static void
13559 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13560 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13561 enum bptype type_wanted,
13562 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13563 {
13564 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13565
13566 lsal.sals = parse_probes (arg, canonical);
13567
13568 *copy_arg = xstrdup (canonical->addr_string);
13569 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13570
13571 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13572 }
13573
13574 static void
13575 bkpt_probe_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13576 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13577 {
13578 *sals = parse_probes (s, NULL);
13579 if (!sals->sals)
13580 error (_("probe not found"));
13581 }
13582
13583 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
13584
13585 static void
13586 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13587 {
13588 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13589 }
13590
13591 static int
13592 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13593 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13594 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13595 {
13596 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
13597 tracepoints. */
13598 return 0;
13599 }
13600
13601 static void
13602 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13603 struct ui_out *uiout)
13604 {
13605 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13606 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
13607 {
13608 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13609
13610 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13611 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13612 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13613 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13614 }
13615 }
13616
13617 static void
13618 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13619 {
13620 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13621 return;
13622
13623 switch (b->type)
13624 {
13625 case bp_tracepoint:
13626 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13627 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13628 break;
13629 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13630 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13631 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13632 break;
13633 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13634 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13635 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13636 break;
13637 default:
13638 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13639 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13640 }
13641
13642 say_where (b);
13643 }
13644
13645 static void
13646 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13647 {
13648 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13649
13650 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13651 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13652 if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13653 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13654 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13655 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13656 else
13657 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13658 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13659
13660 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->addr_string);
13661 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13662
13663 if (tp->pass_count)
13664 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13665 }
13666
13667 static void
13668 tracepoint_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13669 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13670 enum bptype type_wanted,
13671 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13672 {
13673 create_sals_from_address_default (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13674 addr_start, copy_arg);
13675 }
13676
13677 static void
13678 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13679 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13680 char *cond_string,
13681 char *extra_string,
13682 enum bptype type_wanted,
13683 enum bpdisp disposition,
13684 int thread,
13685 int task, int ignore_count,
13686 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13687 int from_tty, int enabled,
13688 int internal, unsigned flags)
13689 {
13690 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13691 cond_string, extra_string,
13692 type_wanted,
13693 disposition, thread, task,
13694 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13695 enabled, internal, flags);
13696 }
13697
13698 static void
13699 tracepoint_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13700 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13701 {
13702 decode_linespec_default (b, s, sals);
13703 }
13704
13705 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13706
13707 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13708 static probe. */
13709
13710 static void
13711 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13712 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13713 enum bptype type_wanted,
13714 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13715 {
13716 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13717 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13718 addr_start, copy_arg);
13719 }
13720
13721 static void
13722 tracepoint_probe_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13723 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13724 {
13725 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13726 bkpt_probe_decode_linespec (b, s, sals);
13727 }
13728
13729 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13730
13731 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13732
13733 static void
13734 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13735 {
13736 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13737
13738 /* This breakpoint could have been pending, and be resolved now, and
13739 if so, we should now have the extra string. If we don't, the
13740 dprintf was malformed when created, but we couldn't tell because
13741 we can't extract the extra string until the location is
13742 resolved. */
13743 if (b->loc != NULL && b->extra_string == NULL)
13744 error (_("Format string required"));
13745
13746 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13747 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13748 3 - disconnect from target 1
13749 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13750
13751 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13752 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13753 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13754 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13755 it all the time. */
13756 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13757 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13758 }
13759
13760 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13761
13762 static void
13763 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13764 {
13765 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s%s", tp->addr_string,
13766 tp->extra_string);
13767 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13768 }
13769
13770 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13771 dprintf.
13772
13773 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13774 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13775 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13776 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13777 address are all handled. */
13778
13779 static void
13780 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13781 {
13782 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13783 struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL };
13784 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13785
13786 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13787 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13788 condition not be evaluated. */
13789 bs->stop = 0;
13790
13791 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13792 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13793 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13794 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13795 commands here throws. */
13796 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13797 bs->commands = NULL;
13798 old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands);
13799
13800 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13801
13802 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13803 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13804 list. */
13805 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13806 }
13807
13808 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13809 markers (`-m'). */
13810
13811 static void
13812 strace_marker_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13813 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13814 enum bptype type_wanted,
13815 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13816 {
13817 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13818
13819 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (arg);
13820
13821 *copy_arg = savestring (addr_start, *arg - addr_start);
13822
13823 canonical->addr_string = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13824 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13825 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13826 }
13827
13828 static void
13829 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13830 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13831 char *cond_string,
13832 char *extra_string,
13833 enum bptype type_wanted,
13834 enum bpdisp disposition,
13835 int thread,
13836 int task, int ignore_count,
13837 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13838 int from_tty, int enabled,
13839 int internal, unsigned flags)
13840 {
13841 int i;
13842 struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals,
13843 canonical->sals, 0);
13844
13845 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13846 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13847 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13848 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13849 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13850 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13851
13852 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13853 {
13854 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13855 struct tracepoint *tp;
13856 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13857 char *addr_string;
13858
13859 expanded.nelts = 1;
13860 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13861
13862 addr_string = xstrdup (canonical->addr_string);
13863 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
13864
13865 tp = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
13866 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13867 addr_string, NULL,
13868 cond_string, extra_string,
13869 type_wanted, disposition,
13870 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13871 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13872 canonical->special_display);
13873 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13874 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13875 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13876 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13877 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13878 corresponds to this one */
13879 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13880
13881 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13882
13883 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13884 }
13885 }
13886
13887 static void
13888 strace_marker_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13889 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13890 {
13891 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13892
13893 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (s);
13894 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13895 {
13896 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13897 sals->nelts = 1;
13898 }
13899 else
13900 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13901 }
13902
13903 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13904
13905 static int
13906 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13907 {
13908 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13909 }
13910
13911 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13912 structures. */
13913
13914 void
13915 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13916 {
13917 struct breakpoint *b;
13918
13919 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13920
13921 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13922 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13923 especial culprits.
13924
13925 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13926 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13927 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13928 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13929 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13930 deleted.
13931
13932 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13933 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13934 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13935 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13936 was chosen. */
13937 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13938 return;
13939
13940 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13941 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13942 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13943 {
13944 struct breakpoint *related;
13945 struct watchpoint *w;
13946
13947 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13948 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13949 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13950 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13951 else
13952 w = NULL;
13953 if (w != NULL)
13954 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13955
13956 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13957 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13958 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13959 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13960 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13961 }
13962
13963 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13964 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13965 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13966 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13967 if (bpt->number)
13968 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13969
13970 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13971 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13972
13973 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13974 if (b->next == bpt)
13975 {
13976 b->next = bpt->next;
13977 break;
13978 }
13979
13980 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13981 been freed. */
13982 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13983 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13984 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13985 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13986 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13987 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13988 commands won't work. */
13989
13990 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13991
13992 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13993 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13994 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13995 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13996 might be better design to have location completely
13997 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13998 update_global_location_list (0);
13999
14000 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
14001 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
14002 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
14003 bpt->type = bp_none;
14004 xfree (bpt);
14005 }
14006
14007 static void
14008 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
14009 {
14010 delete_breakpoint (b);
14011 }
14012
14013 struct cleanup *
14014 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
14015 {
14016 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
14017 }
14018
14019 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
14020 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
14021
14022 static void
14023 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
14024 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14025 void *),
14026 void *data)
14027 {
14028 struct breakpoint *related;
14029
14030 related = b;
14031 do
14032 {
14033 struct breakpoint *next;
14034
14035 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
14036 next = related->related_breakpoint;
14037
14038 if (next == related)
14039 {
14040 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
14041 function (related, data);
14042
14043 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
14044 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
14045 out. */
14046 break;
14047 }
14048 else
14049 function (related, data);
14050
14051 related = next;
14052 }
14053 while (related != b);
14054 }
14055
14056 static void
14057 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14058 {
14059 delete_breakpoint (b);
14060 }
14061
14062 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14063 delete_breakpoint. */
14064
14065 static void
14066 do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14067 {
14068 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14069 }
14070
14071 void
14072 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14073 {
14074 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14075
14076 dont_repeat ();
14077
14078 if (arg == 0)
14079 {
14080 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14081
14082 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
14083 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
14084 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
14085 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14086 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14087 {
14088 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14089 break;
14090 }
14091
14092 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14093 if (!from_tty
14094 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
14095 {
14096 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14097 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14098 delete_breakpoint (b);
14099 }
14100 }
14101 else
14102 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14103 }
14104
14105 static int
14106 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
14107 {
14108 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
14109 if (!loc->shlib_disabled
14110 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14111 return 0;
14112 return 1;
14113 }
14114
14115 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
14116 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
14117 Null names are ignored. */
14118
14119 static int
14120 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
14121 {
14122 struct bp_location *l;
14123 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
14124 (int (*) (const void *,
14125 const void *)) streq,
14126 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14127
14128 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
14129 {
14130 const char **slot;
14131 const char *name = l->function_name;
14132
14133 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
14134 if (name == NULL)
14135 continue;
14136
14137 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
14138 INSERT);
14139 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
14140 returns NULL. */
14141 if (*slot != NULL)
14142 {
14143 htab_delete (htab);
14144 return 1;
14145 }
14146 *slot = name;
14147 }
14148
14149 htab_delete (htab);
14150 return 0;
14151 }
14152
14153 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
14154 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
14155 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
14156 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
14157 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
14158 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
14159 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
14160 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
14161 The heuristic is:
14162
14163 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
14164 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
14165 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
14166 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
14167 in the sources, and output a warning.
14168
14169 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
14170 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
14171 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
14172 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
14173 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
14174 warning.
14175
14176 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
14177 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
14178 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
14179 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
14180 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
14181 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
14182 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
14183 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
14184 precisely because it confuses tools). */
14185
14186 static struct symtab_and_line
14187 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
14188 {
14189 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14190 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
14191 CORE_ADDR pc;
14192
14193 pc = sal.pc;
14194 if (sal.line)
14195 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
14196
14197 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
14198 {
14199 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
14200 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
14201 b->number,
14202 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
14203
14204 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14205 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
14206 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
14207
14208 return sal;
14209 }
14210
14211 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
14212 by string ID. */
14213 if (!sal.explicit_pc
14214 && sal.line != 0
14215 && sal.symtab != NULL
14216 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
14217 {
14218 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
14219
14220 markers
14221 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14222
14223 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
14224 {
14225 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
14226 struct symbol *sym;
14227 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
14228 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14229
14230 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
14231
14232 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14233 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
14234
14235 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
14236 "found at previous line number"),
14237 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14238
14239 init_sal (&sal2);
14240
14241 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
14242
14243 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
14244 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
14245 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
14246 if (sym)
14247 {
14248 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
14249 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
14250 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
14251 }
14252 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
14253 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14254 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
14255
14256 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
14257 {
14258 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
14259
14260 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
14261 }
14262
14263 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
14264 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
14265
14266 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
14267 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
14268
14269 xfree (b->addr_string);
14270 b->addr_string = xstrprintf ("%s:%d",
14271 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
14272 b->loc->line_number);
14273
14274 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
14275 so. */
14276
14277 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
14278 }
14279 }
14280 return sal;
14281 }
14282
14283 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
14284 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
14285
14286 static int
14287 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
14288 {
14289 while (a && b)
14290 {
14291 if (a->address != b->address)
14292 return 0;
14293
14294 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
14295 return 0;
14296
14297 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
14298 return 0;
14299
14300 a = a->next;
14301 b = b->next;
14302 }
14303
14304 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
14305 return 0;
14306
14307 return 1;
14308 }
14309
14310 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software breakpoint)
14311 based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not zero, then B is
14312 a ranged breakpoint. */
14313
14314 void
14315 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
14316 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
14317 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
14318 {
14319 int i;
14320 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
14321
14322 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
14323 {
14324 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
14325 location. */
14326 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14327 update_global_location_list (1);
14328 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
14329 "multiple locations found\n"),
14330 b->number);
14331 return;
14332 }
14333
14334 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
14335 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
14336 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
14337 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
14338 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
14339 individual locations. */
14340 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
14341 return;
14342
14343 b->loc = NULL;
14344
14345 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14346 {
14347 struct bp_location *new_loc;
14348
14349 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
14350
14351 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
14352
14353 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
14354 old symtab. */
14355 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
14356 {
14357 const char *s;
14358 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
14359
14360 s = b->cond_string;
14361 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14362 {
14363 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
14364 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
14365 0);
14366 }
14367 if (e.reason < 0)
14368 {
14369 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
14370 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
14371 b->number, e.message);
14372 new_loc->enabled = 0;
14373 }
14374 }
14375
14376 if (sals_end.nelts)
14377 {
14378 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
14379
14380 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
14381 }
14382 }
14383
14384 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
14385 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
14386 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
14387
14388 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
14389 breakpoints. */
14390 {
14391 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
14392 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
14393 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
14394 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
14395 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
14396 often enough until a better solution is found. */
14397 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
14398
14399 for (; e; e = e->next)
14400 {
14401 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
14402 {
14403 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
14404 if (have_ambiguous_names)
14405 {
14406 for (; l; l = l->next)
14407 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
14408 {
14409 l->enabled = 0;
14410 break;
14411 }
14412 }
14413 else
14414 {
14415 for (; l; l = l->next)
14416 if (l->function_name
14417 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
14418 {
14419 l->enabled = 0;
14420 break;
14421 }
14422 }
14423 }
14424 }
14425 }
14426
14427 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
14428 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14429
14430 update_global_location_list (1);
14431 }
14432
14433 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given ADDR_STRING.
14434 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
14435
14436 static struct symtabs_and_lines
14437 addr_string_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, char *addr_string, int *found)
14438 {
14439 char *s;
14440 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
14441 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
14442
14443 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
14444 s = addr_string;
14445
14446 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14447 {
14448 b->ops->decode_linespec (b, &s, &sals);
14449 }
14450 if (e.reason < 0)
14451 {
14452 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
14453 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
14454 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
14455 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
14456 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
14457 state, then user already saw the message about that
14458 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
14459 errors. */
14460 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
14461 && (b->condition_not_parsed
14462 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
14463 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14464 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
14465 not_found_and_ok = 1;
14466
14467 if (!not_found_and_ok)
14468 {
14469 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
14470 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
14471 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
14472 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
14473 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
14474 which approach is better. */
14475 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14476 throw_exception (e);
14477 }
14478 }
14479
14480 if (e.reason == 0 || e.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
14481 {
14482 int i;
14483
14484 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14485 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
14486 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
14487 {
14488 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
14489 int thread, task;
14490
14491 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
14492 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
14493 &extra_string);
14494 if (cond_string)
14495 b->cond_string = cond_string;
14496 b->thread = thread;
14497 b->task = task;
14498 if (extra_string)
14499 b->extra_string = extra_string;
14500 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
14501 }
14502
14503 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
14504 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
14505
14506 *found = 1;
14507 }
14508 else
14509 *found = 0;
14510
14511 return sals;
14512 }
14513
14514 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
14515 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
14516 locations. */
14517
14518 static void
14519 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
14520 {
14521 int found;
14522 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
14523 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
14524 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
14525
14526 sals = addr_string_to_sals (b, b->addr_string, &found);
14527 if (found)
14528 {
14529 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
14530 expanded = sals;
14531 }
14532
14533 if (b->addr_string_range_end)
14534 {
14535 sals_end = addr_string_to_sals (b, b->addr_string_range_end, &found);
14536 if (found)
14537 {
14538 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
14539 expanded_end = sals_end;
14540 }
14541 }
14542
14543 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded, expanded_end);
14544 }
14545
14546 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
14547 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
14548
14549 static void
14550 create_sals_from_address_default (char **arg,
14551 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14552 enum bptype type_wanted,
14553 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
14554 {
14555 parse_breakpoint_sals (arg, canonical);
14556 }
14557
14558 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
14559 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
14560 breakpoint_ops. */
14561
14562 static void
14563 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14564 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14565 char *cond_string,
14566 char *extra_string,
14567 enum bptype type_wanted,
14568 enum bpdisp disposition,
14569 int thread,
14570 int task, int ignore_count,
14571 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
14572 int from_tty, int enabled,
14573 int internal, unsigned flags)
14574 {
14575 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
14576 extra_string,
14577 type_wanted, disposition,
14578 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
14579 enabled, internal, flags);
14580 }
14581
14582 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
14583 default function for the `decode_linespec' method of breakpoint_ops. */
14584
14585 static void
14586 decode_linespec_default (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
14587 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
14588 {
14589 struct linespec_result canonical;
14590
14591 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
14592 decode_line_full (s, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
14593 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
14594 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
14595 b->filter);
14596
14597 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
14598 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
14599
14600 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
14601 {
14602 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
14603
14604 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
14605 *sals = lsal->sals;
14606 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
14607 contents. */
14608 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
14609 }
14610
14611 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
14612 }
14613
14614 /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
14615
14616 static struct cleanup *
14617 prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
14618 {
14619 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14620
14621 input_radix = b->input_radix;
14622 cleanups = save_current_space_and_thread ();
14623 if (b->pspace != NULL)
14624 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
14625 set_language (b->language);
14626
14627 return cleanups;
14628 }
14629
14630 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
14631 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
14632 Unused in this case. */
14633
14634 static int
14635 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
14636 {
14637 /* Get past catch_errs. */
14638 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
14639 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14640
14641 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
14642 b->ops->re_set (b);
14643 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14644 return 0;
14645 }
14646
14647 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
14648 void
14649 breakpoint_re_set (void)
14650 {
14651 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14652 enum language save_language;
14653 int save_input_radix;
14654 struct cleanup *old_chain;
14655
14656 save_language = current_language->la_language;
14657 save_input_radix = input_radix;
14658 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
14659
14660 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14661 {
14662 /* Format possible error msg. */
14663 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14664 b->number);
14665 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
14666 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
14667 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14668 }
14669 set_language (save_language);
14670 input_radix = save_input_radix;
14671
14672 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14673
14674 do_cleanups (old_chain);
14675
14676 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14677 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14678 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14679 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14680 }
14681 \f
14682 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14683
14684 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14685 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14686 void
14687 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14688 {
14689 if (b->thread != -1)
14690 {
14691 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14692 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14693
14694 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14695 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14696 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14697 as well. */
14698 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14699 }
14700 }
14701
14702 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14703 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14704 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14705
14706 void
14707 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14708 {
14709 struct breakpoint *b;
14710
14711 if (count < 0)
14712 count = 0;
14713
14714 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14715 if (b->number == bptnum)
14716 {
14717 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14718 {
14719 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14720 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14721 bptnum);
14722 return;
14723 }
14724
14725 b->ignore_count = count;
14726 if (from_tty)
14727 {
14728 if (count == 0)
14729 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14730 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14731 bptnum);
14732 else if (count == 1)
14733 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14734 bptnum);
14735 else
14736 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14737 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14738 count, bptnum);
14739 }
14740 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14741 return;
14742 }
14743
14744 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14745 }
14746
14747 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14748
14749 static void
14750 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14751 {
14752 char *p = args;
14753 int num;
14754
14755 if (p == 0)
14756 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14757
14758 num = get_number (&p);
14759 if (num == 0)
14760 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14761 if (*p == 0)
14762 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14763
14764 set_ignore_count (num,
14765 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14766 from_tty);
14767 if (from_tty)
14768 printf_filtered ("\n");
14769 }
14770 \f
14771 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14772 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14773
14774 static void
14775 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14776 void *),
14777 void *data)
14778 {
14779 int num;
14780 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14781 int match;
14782 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
14783
14784 if (args == 0)
14785 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14786
14787 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
14788
14789 while (!state.finished)
14790 {
14791 char *p = state.string;
14792
14793 match = 0;
14794
14795 num = get_number_or_range (&state);
14796 if (num == 0)
14797 {
14798 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14799 }
14800 else
14801 {
14802 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14803 if (b->number == num)
14804 {
14805 match = 1;
14806 function (b, data);
14807 break;
14808 }
14809 if (match == 0)
14810 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14811 }
14812 }
14813 }
14814
14815 static struct bp_location *
14816 find_location_by_number (char *number)
14817 {
14818 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14819 char *p1;
14820 int bp_num;
14821 int loc_num;
14822 struct breakpoint *b;
14823 struct bp_location *loc;
14824
14825 *dot = '\0';
14826
14827 p1 = number;
14828 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14829 if (bp_num == 0)
14830 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14831
14832 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14833 if (b->number == bp_num)
14834 {
14835 break;
14836 }
14837
14838 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14839 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14840
14841 p1 = dot+1;
14842 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14843 if (loc_num == 0)
14844 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14845
14846 --loc_num;
14847 loc = b->loc;
14848 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14849 ;
14850 if (!loc)
14851 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14852
14853 return loc;
14854 }
14855
14856
14857 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14858 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14859 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14860
14861 void
14862 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14863 {
14864 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14865 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14866 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14867 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14868 return;
14869
14870 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
14871 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
14872 return;
14873
14874 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14875
14876 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14877 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14878
14879 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14880 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14881 {
14882 struct bp_location *location;
14883
14884 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14885 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14886 }
14887
14888 update_global_location_list (0);
14889
14890 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14891 }
14892
14893 /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14894
14895 static void
14896 do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14897 {
14898 disable_breakpoint (b);
14899 }
14900
14901 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14902 disable_breakpoint. */
14903
14904 static void
14905 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14906 {
14907 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14908 }
14909
14910 static void
14911 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14912 {
14913 if (args == 0)
14914 {
14915 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14916
14917 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14918 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14919 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14920 }
14921 else
14922 {
14923 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14924
14925 while (num)
14926 {
14927 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14928 {
14929 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14930
14931 if (loc)
14932 {
14933 if (loc->enabled)
14934 {
14935 loc->enabled = 0;
14936 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14937 }
14938 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14939 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14940 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14941 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14942 }
14943 update_global_location_list (0);
14944 }
14945 else
14946 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14947 num = extract_arg (&args);
14948 }
14949 }
14950 }
14951
14952 static void
14953 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14954 int count)
14955 {
14956 int target_resources_ok;
14957
14958 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14959 {
14960 int i;
14961 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14962 target_resources_ok =
14963 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14964 i + 1, 0);
14965 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14966 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14967 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14968 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14969 }
14970
14971 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14972 {
14973 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14974 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = 0;
14975 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
14976
14977 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14978 {
14979 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14980
14981 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14982 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14983 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14984 }
14985 if (e.reason < 0)
14986 {
14987 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14988 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14989 bpt->number);
14990 return;
14991 }
14992 }
14993
14994 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
14995 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14996
14997 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14998
14999 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
15000 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
15001
15002 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
15003 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
15004 {
15005 struct bp_location *location;
15006
15007 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
15008 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
15009 }
15010
15011 bpt->disposition = disposition;
15012 bpt->enable_count = count;
15013 update_global_location_list (1);
15014
15015 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
15016 }
15017
15018
15019 void
15020 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
15021 {
15022 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
15023 }
15024
15025 static void
15026 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15027 {
15028 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15029 }
15030
15031 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
15032 enable_breakpoint. */
15033
15034 static void
15035 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
15036 {
15037 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15038 }
15039
15040 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
15041 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
15042 in stopping the inferior. */
15043
15044 static void
15045 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15046 {
15047 if (args == 0)
15048 {
15049 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15050
15051 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15052 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
15053 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15054 }
15055 else
15056 {
15057 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
15058
15059 while (num)
15060 {
15061 if (strchr (num, '.'))
15062 {
15063 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
15064
15065 if (loc)
15066 {
15067 if (!loc->enabled)
15068 {
15069 loc->enabled = 1;
15070 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
15071 }
15072 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
15073 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
15074 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
15075 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
15076 }
15077 update_global_location_list (1);
15078 }
15079 else
15080 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15081 num = extract_arg (&args);
15082 }
15083 }
15084 }
15085
15086 /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
15087 breakpoints. */
15088
15089 struct disp_data
15090 {
15091 enum bpdisp disp;
15092 int count;
15093 };
15094
15095 static void
15096 do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15097 {
15098 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
15099
15100 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
15101 }
15102
15103 static void
15104 do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15105 {
15106 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
15107
15108 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15109 }
15110
15111 static void
15112 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15113 {
15114 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
15115 }
15116
15117 static void
15118 do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
15119 {
15120 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
15121
15122 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15123 }
15124
15125 static void
15126 enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15127 {
15128 int count = get_number (&args);
15129
15130 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
15131 }
15132
15133 static void
15134 do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15135 {
15136 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
15137
15138 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15139 }
15140
15141 static void
15142 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15143 {
15144 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15145 }
15146 \f
15147 static void
15148 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15149 {
15150 }
15151
15152 static void
15153 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15154 {
15155 }
15156
15157 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
15158 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
15159 GDB itself. */
15160
15161 static void
15162 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
15163 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
15164 const bfd_byte *data)
15165 {
15166 struct breakpoint *bp;
15167
15168 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
15169 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
15170 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
15171 {
15172 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
15173
15174 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
15175 {
15176 struct bp_location *loc;
15177
15178 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15179 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
15180 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
15181 && addr + len > loc->address)
15182 {
15183 value_free (wp->val);
15184 wp->val = NULL;
15185 wp->val_valid = 0;
15186 }
15187 }
15188 }
15189 }
15190
15191 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
15192 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
15193 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
15194 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
15195 someday. */
15196
15197 void *
15198 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
15199 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
15200 {
15201 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
15202 struct bp_location *bl;
15203
15204 bp_tgt = XCNEW (struct bp_target_info);
15205
15206 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
15207 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
15208
15209 /* If an unconditional non-raw breakpoint is already inserted at
15210 that location, there's no need to insert another. However, with
15211 target-side evaluation of breakpoint conditions, if the
15212 breakpoint that is currently inserted on the target is
15213 conditional, we need to make it unconditional. Note that a
15214 breakpoint with target-side commands is not reported even if
15215 unconditional, so we need to remove the commands from the target
15216 as well. */
15217 bl = find_non_raw_software_breakpoint_inserted_here (aspace, pc);
15218 if (bl != NULL
15219 && VEC_empty (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions)
15220 && VEC_empty (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands))
15221 {
15222 bp_target_info_copy_insertion_state (bp_tgt, &bl->target_info);
15223 return bp_tgt;
15224 }
15225
15226 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
15227 {
15228 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
15229 xfree (bp_tgt);
15230 return NULL;
15231 }
15232
15233 return bp_tgt;
15234 }
15235
15236 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by
15237 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
15238
15239 int
15240 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
15241 {
15242 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
15243 struct address_space *aspace = bp_tgt->placed_address_space;
15244 CORE_ADDR address = bp_tgt->placed_address;
15245 struct bp_location *bl;
15246 int ret;
15247
15248 bl = find_non_raw_software_breakpoint_inserted_here (aspace, address);
15249
15250 /* Only remove the raw breakpoint if there are no other non-raw
15251 breakpoints still inserted at this location. Otherwise, we would
15252 be effectively disabling those breakpoints. */
15253 if (bl == NULL)
15254 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
15255 else if (!VEC_empty (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions)
15256 || !VEC_empty (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands))
15257 {
15258 /* The target is evaluating conditions, and when we inserted the
15259 software single-step breakpoint, we had made the breakpoint
15260 unconditional and command-less on the target side. Reinsert
15261 to restore the conditions/commands. */
15262 ret = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
15263 }
15264 else
15265 ret = 0;
15266
15267 xfree (bp_tgt);
15268
15269 return ret;
15270 }
15271
15272 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
15273
15274 void
15275 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
15276 struct address_space *aspace,
15277 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
15278 {
15279 void **bpt_p;
15280
15281 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
15282 {
15283 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
15284 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
15285 }
15286 else
15287 {
15288 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
15289 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
15290 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
15291 }
15292
15293 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would
15294 be to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on
15295 the breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint.
15296 We could adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing
15297 this requires corresponding changes elsewhere where single step
15298 breakpoints are handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
15299
15300 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
15301 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
15302 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
15303 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
15304 }
15305
15306 /* Check if the breakpoints used for software single stepping
15307 were inserted or not. */
15308
15309 int
15310 single_step_breakpoints_inserted (void)
15311 {
15312 return (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL
15313 || single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL);
15314 }
15315
15316 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
15317
15318 void
15319 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
15320 {
15321 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
15322
15323 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
15324 call. */
15325 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
15326 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
15327 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
15328 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
15329
15330 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
15331 {
15332 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
15333 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
15334 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
15335 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
15336 }
15337 }
15338
15339 /* Delete software single step breakpoints without removing them from
15340 the inferior. This is intended to be used if the inferior's address
15341 space where they were inserted is already gone, e.g. after exit or
15342 exec. */
15343
15344 void
15345 cancel_single_step_breakpoints (void)
15346 {
15347 int i;
15348
15349 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
15350 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
15351 {
15352 xfree (single_step_breakpoints[i]);
15353 single_step_breakpoints[i] = NULL;
15354 single_step_gdbarch[i] = NULL;
15355 }
15356 }
15357
15358 /* Detach software single-step breakpoints from INFERIOR_PTID without
15359 removing them. */
15360
15361 static void
15362 detach_single_step_breakpoints (void)
15363 {
15364 int i;
15365
15366 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
15367 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
15368 target_remove_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[i],
15369 single_step_breakpoints[i]);
15370 }
15371
15372 /* Find the software single-step breakpoint that inserted at PC.
15373 Returns its slot if found, and -1 if not found. */
15374
15375 static int
15376 find_single_step_breakpoint (struct address_space *aspace,
15377 CORE_ADDR pc)
15378 {
15379 int i;
15380
15381 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
15382 {
15383 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
15384 if (bp_tgt
15385 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
15386 bp_tgt->placed_address,
15387 aspace, pc))
15388 return i;
15389 }
15390
15391 return -1;
15392 }
15393
15394 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
15395 PC. */
15396
15397 int
15398 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
15399 CORE_ADDR pc)
15400 {
15401 return find_single_step_breakpoint (aspace, pc) >= 0;
15402 }
15403
15404 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
15405 non-zero otherwise. */
15406 static int
15407 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
15408 {
15409 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
15410 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
15411 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
15412 return 1;
15413 else
15414 return 0;
15415 }
15416
15417 int
15418 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
15419 {
15420 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
15421 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
15422
15423 return inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0;
15424 }
15425
15426 int
15427 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
15428 {
15429 struct breakpoint *bp;
15430
15431 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
15432 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
15433 {
15434 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bp;
15435
15436 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
15437 {
15438 int i, iter;
15439 for (i = 0;
15440 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
15441 i++)
15442 if (syscall_number == iter)
15443 return 1;
15444 }
15445 else
15446 return 1;
15447 }
15448
15449 return 0;
15450 }
15451
15452 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
15453 static VEC (char_ptr) *
15454 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
15455 const char *text, const char *word)
15456 {
15457 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
15458 VEC (char_ptr) *retlist
15459 = (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, word, word);
15460
15461 xfree (list);
15462 return retlist;
15463 }
15464
15465 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
15466
15467 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
15468 static void
15469 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
15470 {
15471 tracepoint_count = num;
15472 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
15473 }
15474
15475 static void
15476 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15477 {
15478 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15479 const char *arg_cp = arg;
15480
15481 if (arg && probe_linespec_to_ops (&arg_cp))
15482 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15483 else
15484 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15485
15486 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15487 arg,
15488 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
15489 0 /* tempflag */,
15490 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15491 0 /* Ignore count */,
15492 pending_break_support,
15493 ops,
15494 from_tty,
15495 1 /* enabled */,
15496 0 /* internal */, 0);
15497 }
15498
15499 static void
15500 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15501 {
15502 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15503 arg,
15504 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
15505 0 /* tempflag */,
15506 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15507 0 /* Ignore count */,
15508 pending_break_support,
15509 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15510 from_tty,
15511 1 /* enabled */,
15512 0 /* internal */, 0);
15513 }
15514
15515 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
15516
15517 static void
15518 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15519 {
15520 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15521
15522 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
15523 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
15524 if (arg && strncmp (arg, "-m", 2) == 0 && isspace (arg[2]))
15525 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15526 else
15527 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15528
15529 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15530 arg,
15531 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
15532 0 /* tempflag */,
15533 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15534 0 /* Ignore count */,
15535 pending_break_support,
15536 ops,
15537 from_tty,
15538 1 /* enabled */,
15539 0 /* internal */, 0);
15540 }
15541
15542 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
15543 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
15544
15545 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
15546 static int next_cmd;
15547
15548 static char *
15549 read_uploaded_action (void)
15550 {
15551 char *rslt;
15552
15553 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
15554
15555 next_cmd++;
15556
15557 return rslt;
15558 }
15559
15560 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
15561 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
15562 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
15563 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
15564 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
15565
15566 struct tracepoint *
15567 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
15568 {
15569 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
15570 struct tracepoint *tp;
15571
15572 if (utp->at_string)
15573 addr_str = utp->at_string;
15574 else
15575 {
15576 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
15577 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
15578 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
15579 user. */
15580 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
15581 "source location, using raw address"),
15582 utp->number);
15583 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
15584 addr_str = small_buf;
15585 }
15586
15587 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
15588 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
15589 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
15590 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
15591 utp->number);
15592
15593 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15594 addr_str,
15595 utp->cond_string, -1, NULL,
15596 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
15597 0 /* tempflag */,
15598 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
15599 0 /* Ignore count */,
15600 pending_break_support,
15601 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15602 0 /* from_tty */,
15603 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
15604 0 /* internal */,
15605 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
15606 return NULL;
15607
15608 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
15609 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
15610 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
15611
15612 if (utp->pass > 0)
15613 {
15614 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
15615 tp->base.number);
15616
15617 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
15618 }
15619
15620 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
15621 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
15622 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
15623 function. */
15624 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
15625 {
15626 struct command_line *cmd_list;
15627
15628 this_utp = utp;
15629 next_cmd = 0;
15630
15631 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
15632
15633 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
15634 }
15635 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
15636 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
15637 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
15638 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
15639 utp->number);
15640
15641 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
15642 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
15643 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
15644
15645 return tp;
15646 }
15647
15648 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
15649 omitted. */
15650
15651 static void
15652 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
15653 {
15654 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
15655 int num_printed;
15656
15657 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
15658
15659 if (num_printed == 0)
15660 {
15661 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
15662 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
15663 else
15664 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
15665 }
15666
15667 default_collect_info ();
15668 }
15669
15670 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
15671 Not supported by all targets. */
15672 static void
15673 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15674 {
15675 enable_command (args, from_tty);
15676 }
15677
15678 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
15679 Not supported by all targets. */
15680 static void
15681 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15682 {
15683 disable_command (args, from_tty);
15684 }
15685
15686 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
15687 static void
15688 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15689 {
15690 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15691
15692 dont_repeat ();
15693
15694 if (arg == 0)
15695 {
15696 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
15697
15698 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
15699 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
15700 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
15701 argument. */
15702 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15703 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15704 {
15705 breaks_to_delete = 1;
15706 break;
15707 }
15708
15709 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
15710 if (!from_tty
15711 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15712 {
15713 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15714 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15715 delete_breakpoint (b);
15716 }
15717 }
15718 else
15719 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15720 }
15721
15722 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15723
15724 static void
15725 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15726 {
15727 tp->pass_count = count;
15728 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base);
15729 if (from_tty)
15730 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15731 tp->base.number, count);
15732 }
15733
15734 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15735
15736 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15737 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15738 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15739
15740 static void
15741 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15742 {
15743 struct tracepoint *t1;
15744 unsigned int count;
15745
15746 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15747 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15748 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15749
15750 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15751
15752 args = skip_spaces (args);
15753 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15754 {
15755 struct breakpoint *b;
15756
15757 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15758 if (*args)
15759 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15760
15761 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15762 {
15763 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15764 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15765 }
15766 }
15767 else if (*args == '\0')
15768 {
15769 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15770 if (t1)
15771 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15772 }
15773 else
15774 {
15775 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
15776
15777 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
15778 while (!state.finished)
15779 {
15780 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &state);
15781 if (t1)
15782 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15783 }
15784 }
15785 }
15786
15787 struct tracepoint *
15788 get_tracepoint (int num)
15789 {
15790 struct breakpoint *t;
15791
15792 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15793 if (t->number == num)
15794 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15795
15796 return NULL;
15797 }
15798
15799 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15800 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15801 reconnecting). */
15802
15803 struct tracepoint *
15804 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15805 {
15806 struct breakpoint *b;
15807
15808 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15809 {
15810 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15811
15812 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15813 return t;
15814 }
15815
15816 return NULL;
15817 }
15818
15819 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15820 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15821 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15822 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15823
15824 struct tracepoint *
15825 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15826 struct get_number_or_range_state *state)
15827 {
15828 struct breakpoint *t;
15829 int tpnum;
15830 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15831
15832 if (state)
15833 {
15834 gdb_assert (!state->finished);
15835 tpnum = get_number_or_range (state);
15836 }
15837 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15838 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15839 else
15840 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15841
15842 if (tpnum <= 0)
15843 {
15844 if (instring && *instring)
15845 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15846 instring);
15847 else
15848 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15849 return NULL;
15850 }
15851
15852 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15853 if (t->number == tpnum)
15854 {
15855 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15856 }
15857
15858 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15859 return NULL;
15860 }
15861
15862 void
15863 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15864 {
15865 if (b->thread != -1)
15866 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15867
15868 if (b->task != 0)
15869 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15870
15871 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15872 }
15873
15874 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15875 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15876 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15877 non-zero. */
15878
15879 static void
15880 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15881 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15882 {
15883 struct breakpoint *tp;
15884 int any = 0;
15885 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15886 struct ui_file *fp;
15887 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15888
15889 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15890 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15891
15892 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15893 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15894 {
15895 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15896 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15897 continue;
15898
15899 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15900 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15901 continue;
15902
15903 any = 1;
15904
15905 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15906 {
15907 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15908
15909 /* We can stop searching. */
15910 break;
15911 }
15912 }
15913
15914 if (!any)
15915 {
15916 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15917 return;
15918 }
15919
15920 filename = tilde_expand (filename);
15921 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename);
15922 fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w");
15923 if (!fp)
15924 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15925 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15926 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15927
15928 if (extra_trace_bits)
15929 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15930
15931 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15932 {
15933 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15934 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15935 continue;
15936
15937 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15938 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15939 continue;
15940
15941 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15942
15943 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15944 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15945 instead. */
15946
15947 if (tp->cond_string)
15948 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15949
15950 if (tp->ignore_count)
15951 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15952
15953 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15954 {
15955 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
15956
15957 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15958
15959 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15960 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15961 {
15962 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15963 }
15964 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15965
15966 if (ex.reason < 0)
15967 throw_exception (ex);
15968
15969 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15970 }
15971
15972 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15973 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable\n");
15974
15975 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15976 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15977 special, and not user visible. */
15978 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15979 {
15980 struct bp_location *loc;
15981 int n = 1;
15982
15983 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15984 if (!loc->enabled)
15985 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15986 }
15987 }
15988
15989 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15990 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15991
15992 if (from_tty)
15993 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15994 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15995 }
15996
15997 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15998
15999 static void
16000 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
16001 {
16002 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
16003 }
16004
16005 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
16006
16007 static void
16008 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
16009 {
16010 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
16011 }
16012
16013 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
16014
16015 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
16016 all_tracepoints (void)
16017 {
16018 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
16019 struct breakpoint *tp;
16020
16021 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
16022 {
16023 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
16024 }
16025
16026 return tp_vec;
16027 }
16028
16029 \f
16030 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
16031 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
16032 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
16033 command. */
16034 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
16035 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
16036 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
16037 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
16038 guessed probe type) or `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe).\n\
16039 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
16040 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
16041 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
16042 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
16043 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
16044 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
16045 \n\
16046 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
16047 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16048 \n\
16049 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16050 conditions are different.\n\
16051 \n\
16052 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
16053
16054 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
16055 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
16056
16057 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
16058 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
16059
16060 void
16061 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
16062 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
16063 completer_ftype *completer,
16064 void *user_data_catch,
16065 void *user_data_tcatch)
16066 {
16067 struct cmd_list_element *command;
16068
16069 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
16070 &catch_cmdlist);
16071 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
16072 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
16073 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
16074
16075 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
16076 &tcatch_cmdlist);
16077 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
16078 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
16079 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
16080 }
16081
16082 static void
16083 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
16084 {
16085 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
16086 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
16087
16088 inf_data->total_syscalls_count = 0;
16089 inf_data->any_syscall_count = 0;
16090 VEC_free (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts);
16091 }
16092
16093 static void
16094 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
16095 {
16096 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
16097 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
16098 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
16099 }
16100
16101 struct breakpoint *
16102 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
16103 void *data)
16104 {
16105 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
16106
16107 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
16108 {
16109 if ((*callback) (b, data))
16110 return b;
16111 }
16112
16113 return NULL;
16114 }
16115
16116 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
16117 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
16118
16119 static int
16120 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
16121 {
16122 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
16123 non-inline function. */
16124 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
16125 return 1;
16126
16127 return 0;
16128 }
16129
16130 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
16131 have been inlined. */
16132
16133 int
16134 pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
16135 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
16136 {
16137 struct breakpoint *b;
16138 struct bp_location *bl;
16139
16140 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
16141 {
16142 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
16143 continue;
16144
16145 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
16146 {
16147 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
16148 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
16149 return 1;
16150 }
16151 }
16152
16153 return 0;
16154 }
16155
16156 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
16157
16158 void
16159 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
16160 {
16161 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
16162
16163 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
16164 if (loc->symtab != NULL && loc->symtab->objfile == objfile)
16165 loc->symtab = NULL;
16166 }
16167
16168 void
16169 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
16170 {
16171 static int initialized = 0;
16172
16173 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
16174
16175 if (initialized)
16176 return;
16177 initialized = 1;
16178
16179 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
16180 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
16181 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
16182 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16183 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16184 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16185 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
16186 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
16187 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
16188 ops->create_sals_from_address = bkpt_create_sals_from_address;
16189 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
16190 ops->decode_linespec = bkpt_decode_linespec;
16191
16192 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
16193 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16194 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16195 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16196 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16197 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16198 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16199 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
16200
16201 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
16202 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
16203 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16204 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
16205 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
16206 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
16207 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
16208 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
16209 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
16210 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
16211
16212 /* Internal breakpoints. */
16213 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
16214 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16215 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
16216 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
16217 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
16218 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
16219
16220 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
16221 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16222 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16223 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
16224 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
16225 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
16226 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
16227
16228 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
16229 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
16230 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16231 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
16232
16233 /* Probe breakpoints. */
16234 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16235 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16236 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
16237 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
16238 ops->create_sals_from_address = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address;
16239 ops->decode_linespec = bkpt_probe_decode_linespec;
16240
16241 /* Watchpoints. */
16242 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16243 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16244 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
16245 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
16246 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
16247 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
16248 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
16249 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
16250 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
16251 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
16252 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
16253 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
16254 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
16255 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
16256
16257 /* Masked watchpoints. */
16258 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16259 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16260 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
16261 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
16262 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
16263 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
16264 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
16265 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
16266 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
16267 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
16268
16269 /* Tracepoints. */
16270 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16271 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16272 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
16273 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
16274 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
16275 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
16276 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
16277 ops->create_sals_from_address = tracepoint_create_sals_from_address;
16278 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
16279 ops->decode_linespec = tracepoint_decode_linespec;
16280
16281 /* Probe tracepoints. */
16282 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16283 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16284 ops->create_sals_from_address = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_address;
16285 ops->decode_linespec = tracepoint_probe_decode_linespec;
16286
16287 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
16288 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
16289 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16290 ops->create_sals_from_address = strace_marker_create_sals_from_address;
16291 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
16292 ops->decode_linespec = strace_marker_decode_linespec;
16293
16294 /* Fork catchpoints. */
16295 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
16296 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16297 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
16298 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
16299 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
16300 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
16301 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
16302 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
16303 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
16304
16305 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
16306 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
16307 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16308 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
16309 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
16310 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
16311 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
16312 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
16313 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
16314 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
16315
16316 /* Exec catchpoints. */
16317 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
16318 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16319 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
16320 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
16321 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
16322 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
16323 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
16324 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
16325 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
16326 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
16327
16328 /* Syscall catchpoints. */
16329 ops = &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops;
16330 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16331 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_syscall;
16332 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_syscall;
16333 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_syscall;
16334 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall;
16335 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_syscall;
16336 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_syscall;
16337 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_syscall;
16338 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_syscall;
16339
16340 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
16341 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
16342 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16343 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
16344 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
16345 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
16346 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
16347 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
16348 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
16349 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
16350 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
16351 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
16352
16353 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
16354 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16355 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
16356 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16357 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16358 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16359 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
16360 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
16361 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
16362 }
16363
16364 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
16365
16366 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
16367
16368 void
16369 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
16370 {
16371 struct cmd_list_element *c;
16372
16373 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
16374
16375 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
16376 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
16377 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
16378 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
16379
16380 breakpoint_objfile_key
16381 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
16382
16383 catch_syscall_inferior_data
16384 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (NULL,
16385 catch_syscall_inferior_data_cleanup);
16386
16387 breakpoint_chain = 0;
16388 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
16389 before a breakpoint is set. */
16390 breakpoint_count = 0;
16391
16392 tracepoint_count = 0;
16393
16394 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
16395 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
16396 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
16397 if (xdb_commands)
16398 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
16399
16400 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
16401 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
16402 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
16403 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
16404 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
16405 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
16406 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
16407 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
16408
16409 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
16410 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
16411 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
16412 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
16413 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
16414
16415 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
16416 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
16417 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16418 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
16419 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
16420 \n"
16421 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
16422 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16423
16424 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
16425 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16426 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
16427 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
16428 \n"
16429 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
16430 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16431
16432 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
16433 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16434 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16435 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
16436 \n"
16437 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
16438 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16439
16440 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16441 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16442 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16443 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16444 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16445 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
16446 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16447 if (xdb_commands)
16448 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16449 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16450 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16451 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16452 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16453 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
16454
16455 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16456
16457 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16458 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16459 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16460 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16461 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
16462 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
16463
16464 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16465 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16466 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16467 &enablebreaklist);
16468
16469 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16470 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16471 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16472 &enablebreaklist);
16473
16474 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16475 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16476 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16477 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16478 &enablebreaklist);
16479
16480 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16481 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16482 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16483 &enablelist);
16484
16485 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16486 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16487 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16488 &enablelist);
16489
16490 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16491 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16492 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16493 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16494 &enablelist);
16495
16496 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16497 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16498 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16499 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16500 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
16501 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16502 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16503 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16504 if (xdb_commands)
16505 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16506 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16507 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16508 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16509 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."));
16510
16511 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
16512 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16513 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16514 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16515 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
16516 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
16517 &disablelist);
16518
16519 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16520 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16521 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16522 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16523 \n\
16524 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
16525 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
16526 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
16527 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16528 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16529 if (xdb_commands)
16530 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16531 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
16532 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16533 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
16534
16535 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
16536 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16537 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16538 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16539 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
16540 &deletelist);
16541
16542 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
16543 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
16544 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
16545 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
16546 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
16547 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
16548 \n\
16549 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
16550 is executing in.\n\
16551 \n\
16552 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
16553 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
16554
16555 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
16556 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
16557 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
16558 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16559
16560 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
16561 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
16562 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
16563 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
16564
16565 if (xdb_commands)
16566 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
16567
16568 if (dbx_commands)
16569 {
16570 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
16571 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
16572 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
16573 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
16574 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
16575 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
16576 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
16577 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
16578 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16579 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16580 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16581 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16582 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16583 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16584 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16585 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16586 \n\
16587 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16588 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16589 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16590 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16591 breakpoint set."));
16592 }
16593
16594 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
16595 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
16596 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16597 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16598 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16599 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16600 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16601 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16602 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16603 \n\
16604 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16605 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16606 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16607 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16608 breakpoint set."));
16609
16610 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
16611
16612 if (xdb_commands)
16613 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
16614 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16615 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16616 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16617 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16618 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16619 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16620 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16621 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16622 \n\
16623 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16624 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16625 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16626 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16627 breakpoint set."));
16628
16629 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
16630 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16631 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16632 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16633 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16634 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
16635 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
16636 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
16637 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
16638 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16639 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16640 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16641 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16642 \n\
16643 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16644 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16645 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16646 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16647 breakpoint set."),
16648 &maintenanceinfolist);
16649
16650 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
16651 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
16652 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
16653 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16654
16655 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
16656 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
16657 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
16658 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16659
16660 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
16661 catch_fork_command_1,
16662 NULL,
16663 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
16664 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
16665 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
16666 catch_fork_command_1,
16667 NULL,
16668 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
16669 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
16670 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
16671 catch_exec_command_1,
16672 NULL,
16673 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16674 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16675 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
16676 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
16677 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16678 catch_load_command_1,
16679 NULL,
16680 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16681 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16682 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
16683 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
16684 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16685 catch_unload_command_1,
16686 NULL,
16687 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16688 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16689 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
16690 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
16691 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
16692 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
16693 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
16694 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
16695 catch_syscall_command_1,
16696 catch_syscall_completer,
16697 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16698 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16699
16700 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
16701 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16702 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16703 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16704 an expression changes.\n\
16705 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16706 the memory to which it refers."));
16707 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16708
16709 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16710 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16711 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16712 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16713 an expression is read.\n\
16714 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16715 the memory to which it refers."));
16716 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16717
16718 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16719 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16720 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16721 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16722 an expression is either read or written.\n\
16723 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16724 the memory to which it refers."));
16725 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16726
16727 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16728 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16729
16730 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16731 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16732 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16733 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16734 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16735 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16736 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16737 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16738 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16739 hardware.)"),
16740 NULL,
16741 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16742 &setlist, &showlist);
16743
16744 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16745
16746 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16747
16748 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16749 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
16750 \n"
16751 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16752 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16753 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16754
16755 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16756 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16757 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16758 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16759
16760 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16761 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
16762 \n"
16763 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16764 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16765 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16766
16767 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16768 Set a static tracepoint at specified line, function or marker.\n\
16769 \n\
16770 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16771 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, \"*\" and an address,\n\
16772 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\
16773 If a line number is specified, probe the marker at start of code\n\
16774 for that line. If a function is specified, probe the marker at start\n\
16775 of code for that function. If an address is specified, probe the marker\n\
16776 at that exact address. If a marker id is specified, probe the marker\n\
16777 with that name. With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of\n\
16778 the selected stack frame.\n\
16779 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16780 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16781 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16782 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16783 \n\
16784 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16785 \n\
16786 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16787 conditions are different.\n\
16788 \n\
16789 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16790 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16791 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16792
16793 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16794 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16795 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16796 last tracepoint set."));
16797
16798 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16799
16800 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16801 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16802 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16803 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16804 &deletelist);
16805 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16806
16807 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16808 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16809 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16810 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16811 &disablelist);
16812 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16813
16814 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16815 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16816 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16817 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16818 &enablelist);
16819 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16820
16821 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16822 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16823 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16824 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16825 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16826
16827 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16828 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16829 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16830 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16831
16832 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16833 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16834 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16835 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16836 session to restore them."),
16837 &save_cmdlist);
16838 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16839
16840 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16841 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16842 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16843 &save_cmdlist);
16844 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16845
16846 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16847 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16848
16849 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16850 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16851 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16852 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16853 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16854 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16855 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16856 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16857 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16858 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16859 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16860 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16861
16862 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16863 &pending_break_support, _("\
16864 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16865 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16866 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16867 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16868 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16869 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16870 NULL,
16871 show_pending_break_support,
16872 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16873 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16874
16875 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16876
16877 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16878 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16879 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16880 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16881 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16882 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16883 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16884 NULL,
16885 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16886 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16887 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16888
16889 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16890 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16891 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16892 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16893 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
16894 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
16895 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
16896 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
16897 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
16898 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
16899 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
16900 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
16901 NULL,
16902 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16903 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16904 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16905
16906 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16907 condition_evaluation_enums,
16908 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16909 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16910 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16911 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16912 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16913 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16914 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16915 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16916 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16917 be set to \"gdb\""),
16918 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16919 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16920 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16921 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16922
16923 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16924 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16925 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16926 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16927 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16928 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16929 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16930 or the start of the range\n\
16931 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16932 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16933 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16934 \n\
16935 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16936 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16937 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16938
16939 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16940 Set a dynamic printf at specified line or function.\n\
16941 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16942 location may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
16943 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
16944 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function."));
16945 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16946
16947 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16948 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16949 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16950 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16951 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16952 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16953 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16954 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16955 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16956 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16957 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16958 &setlist, &showlist);
16959
16960 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16961 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16962 &dprintf_function, _("\
16963 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16964 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16965 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16966 &setlist, &showlist);
16967
16968 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16969 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16970 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16971 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16972 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16973 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16974 &setlist, &showlist);
16975
16976 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16977 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16978 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16979 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16980 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16981 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16982 NULL,
16983 NULL,
16984 &setlist, &showlist);
16985
16986 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16987 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16988 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16989
16990 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16991
16992 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16993 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16994 }
This page took 0.377034 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.